blob: 1092fd5e248a735ed20091c2fd9929160e778112 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau2e077f82019-11-25 20:36:16 +01005 version 2.2
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaud0089302020-04-17 14:19:38 +02007 2020/04/17
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020056
574. Proxies
584.1. Proxy keywords matrix
594.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
60
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100615. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200625.1. Bind options
635.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200645.3. Server DNS resolution
655.3.1. Global overview
665.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020067
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100686. Cache
696.1. Limitation
706.2. Setup
716.2.1. Cache section
726.2.2. Proxy section
73
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200747. Using ACLs and fetching samples
757.1. ACL basics
767.1.1. Matching booleans
777.1.2. Matching integers
787.1.3. Matching strings
797.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
807.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
817.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
827.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
837.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200847.3.1. Converters
857.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
867.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
877.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
887.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
897.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Fauletba3c68f2020-04-01 16:27:05 +0200907.3.7. Fetching health-check samples
917.3.8. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200927.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093
948. Logging
958.1. Log levels
968.2. Log formats
978.2.1. Default log format
988.2.2. TCP log format
998.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001008.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001018.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001028.3. Advanced logging options
1038.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1048.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1058.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1068.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1078.4. Timing events
1088.5. Session state at disconnection
1098.6. Non-printable characters
1108.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1118.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1128.9. Examples of logs
113
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001149. Supported filters
1159.1. Trace
1169.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001179.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001189.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001199.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200120
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012110. FastCGI applications
12210.1. Setup
12310.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12410.1.2. Proxy section
12510.1.3. Example
12610.2. Default parameters
12710.3. Limitations
128
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129
1301. Quick reminder about HTTP
131----------------------------
132
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100133When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200134fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
135on almost anything found in the contents.
136
137However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
138formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
139correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
140
141
1421.1. The HTTP transaction model
143-------------------------------
144
145The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100146to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100147from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
148connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149will involve a new connection :
150
151 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
152
153In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
154establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
155by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
156length.
157
158Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
159to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
160however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
161response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
162header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
163
164 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
165
166Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
167power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
168but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200169a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100171Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
173second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
174page :
175
176 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
177
178This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
179latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
180correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
181the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100182server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100184The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
185time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
186are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
187parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
188carry the stream identifier.
189
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100190By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
191connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
192leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100193start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
194processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
195waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200196
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200197HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100198 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
199 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100200 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100201 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200202 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100203
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100204For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
205the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100206server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
207is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
208servers.
209
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200210
2111.2. HTTP request
212-----------------
213
214First, let's consider this HTTP request :
215
216 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100217 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200218 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
219 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
220 3 User-agent: my small browser
221 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
222 5 Accept: image/png
223
224
2251.2.1. The Request line
226-----------------------
227
228Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
229
230 - a METHOD : GET
231 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
232 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
233
234All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
235which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
236followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
237is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
238desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
239the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
240
241The URI itself can have several forms :
242
243 - A "relative URI" :
244
245 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
246
247 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
248 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
249
250 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
251
252 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
253
254 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
255 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
256 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
257 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
258 must accept this form too.
259
260 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
261 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
262 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100263
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200264 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
265 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
266 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
267 other protocols too.
268
269In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
270mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
271on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
272It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
273specific to the language, framework or application in use.
274
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100275HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100276assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100277However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
278received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
279processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
280as well as in server logs.
281
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200282
2831.2.2. The request headers
284--------------------------
285
286The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
287beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
288an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
289Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
290values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
291encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
292the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
293define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
294
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100295Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200296their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100297"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
298as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299
300The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
301that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
302is one valid form of empty line.
303
304Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
305headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
306about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
307application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
308
309Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000310 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200311 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
312 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
313 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
314
315
3161.3. HTTP response
317------------------
318
319An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
320messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
321
322 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100323 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200324 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
325 2 Content-length: 350
326 3 Content-Type: text/html
327
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200328As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
329codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
330response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100331continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
332the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
333following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
334sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
335(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
336correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
337such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
338state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
339over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
340if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
341information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200342
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200343
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003441.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200345------------------------
346
347Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
348
349 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
350 - a status code : 200
351 - a reason : OK
352
353The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100354 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
355 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
356 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
357 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
358 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200359
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000360Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100361"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200362found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
363messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
364or "Authentication Required".
365
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100366HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200367
368 Code When / reason
369 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
370 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
371 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
372 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100373 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
374 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200375 400 for an invalid or too large request
376 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
377 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200378 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100379 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200380 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100381 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
382 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200383 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
384 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
385 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200386 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200387 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
388 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
389 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
390
391The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3924.2).
393
394
3951.3.2. The response headers
396---------------------------
397
398Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
399the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
400details.
401
402
4032. Configuring HAProxy
404----------------------
405
4062.1. Configuration file format
407------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200408
409HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
410
411 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
412 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
413 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
414 "frontend" and "backend".
415
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100416The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
417referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200418delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100419
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200420
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004212.2. Quoting and escaping
422-------------------------
423
424HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
425many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
426with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
427single quotes.
428
429If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
430them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
431escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
432
433Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
434
435 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
436 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
437 \\ to use a backslash
438 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
439 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
440
441Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
442the interpretation of:
443
444 space as a parameter separator
445 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
446 # hash as a comment start
447
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200448Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
449-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
450backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
451
452Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200453quoting.
454
455Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
456nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
457
458Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
459equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
460
461 Example:
462 # those are equivalents:
463 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
464 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
465 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
466 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
467 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
468
469 # those are equivalents:
470 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
471 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
472 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
473 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
474
475
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004762.3. Environment variables
477--------------------------
478
479HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
480interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
481configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
482optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
483shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
484underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
485
486 Example:
487
488 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
489
490 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
491
492 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
493
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200494Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
495file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200496
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200497* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
498 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
499
500* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
501 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
502 directory.
503
504* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
505
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500506* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200507 processes, separated by semicolons.
508
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500509* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200510 CLI, separated by semicolons.
511
512See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200513
5142.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200515----------------
516
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100517Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100518values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
519otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
520numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
521for every keyword. Supported units are :
522
523 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
524 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
525 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
526 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
527 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
528 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
529
530
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005312.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200532-------------
533
534 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
535 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
536 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
537 global
538 daemon
539 maxconn 256
540
541 defaults
542 mode http
543 timeout connect 5000ms
544 timeout client 50000ms
545 timeout server 50000ms
546
547 frontend http-in
548 bind *:80
549 default_backend servers
550
551 backend servers
552 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
553
554
555 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
556 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
557 global
558 daemon
559 maxconn 256
560
561 defaults
562 mode http
563 timeout connect 5000ms
564 timeout client 50000ms
565 timeout server 50000ms
566
567 listen http-in
568 bind *:80
569 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
570
571
572Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
573
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100574 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200575
576
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005773. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200578--------------------
579
580Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
581are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
582of them have command-line equivalents.
583
584The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
585
586 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200587 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200588 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200589 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200590 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200591 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200592 - description
593 - deviceatlas-json-file
594 - deviceatlas-log-level
595 - deviceatlas-separator
596 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900597 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200598 - gid
599 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100600 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200601 - h1-case-adjust
602 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100603 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100604 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100605 - issuers-chain-path
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200606 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200607 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100608 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200609 - lua-load
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100610 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200611 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200612 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200613 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200614 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200615 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100616 - presetenv
617 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200618 - uid
619 - ulimit-n
620 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200621 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100622 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200623 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200624 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200625 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200626 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200627 - ssl-default-bind-options
628 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200629 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200630 - ssl-default-server-options
631 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100632 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200633 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100634 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100635 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100636 - 51degrees-data-file
637 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200638 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200639 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200640 - wurfl-data-file
641 - wurfl-information-list
642 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200643 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100644 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100645
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200646 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100647 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200648 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200649 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200650 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100651 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100652 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100653 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200654 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200655 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200656 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200657 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200658 - noepoll
659 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000660 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200661 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100662 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300663 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000664 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100665 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200666 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200667 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200668 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000669 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000670 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200671 - tune.buffers.limit
672 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200673 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200674 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100675 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200676 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200677 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200678 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100679 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200680 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200681 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100682 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100683 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100684 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100685 - tune.lua.session-timeout
686 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200687 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100688 - tune.maxaccept
689 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200690 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200691 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200692 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100693 - tune.rcvbuf.client
694 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100695 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200696 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100697 - tune.sndbuf.client
698 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100699 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100700 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200701 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100702 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200703 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200704 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100705 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200706 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100707 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200708 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
709 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
710 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100711 - tune.zlib.memlevel
712 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100713
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200714 * Debugging
715 - debug
716 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +0200717 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200718
719
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007203.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200721------------------------------------
722
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200723ca-base <dir>
724 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +0100725 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
726 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
727 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200728
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200729chroot <jail dir>
730 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
731 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
732 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
733 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
734 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100735 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100736
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100737cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
738 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
739 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
740 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
741 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
742 set. These sets have the format
743
744 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
745
746 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100747 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100748 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
749 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100750 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
751 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100752 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100753 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100754 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100755 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100756 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
757 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
758 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
759 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100760
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100761 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
762 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
763 on the machine's word size.
764
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100765 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100766 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
767 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
768 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
769 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
770 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
771 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100772
773 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100774 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
775
776 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
777 # first 4 CPUs
778
779 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
780 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
781 # word size.
782
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100783 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100784 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100785 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
786 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
787 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
788
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100789 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
790 # and so on.
791 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
792 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
793 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
794
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100795 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100796 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
797 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
798 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
799
800 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
801 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
802 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
803
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100804 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
805 # and a thread range.
806 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
807 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
808 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
809
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200810crt-base <dir>
811 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +0100812 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
813 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200814
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200815daemon
816 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
817 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100818 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
819 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200820
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200821deviceatlas-json-file <path>
822 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100823 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200824
825deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100826 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200827 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
828
829deviceatlas-separator <char>
830 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
831 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
832
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100833deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200834 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
835 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
836 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100837
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900838external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100839 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
840 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100841 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
842 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
843 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
844 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
845 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900846
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200847gid <number>
848 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
849 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
850 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100851 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
852 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200853 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100854
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100855group <group name>
856 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
857 See also "gid" and "user".
858
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100859hard-stop-after <time>
860 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
861
862 Arguments :
863 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
864 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
865 SIGUSR1 signal.
866
867 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
868 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
869 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
870
871 Example:
872 global
873 hard-stop-after 30s
874
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200875h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
876 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
877 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
878 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
879 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +0500880 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200881 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
882 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
883 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
884 specified in a proxy.
885
886 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
887 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
888 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
889 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
890 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
891 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
892 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
893
894 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
895 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
896 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
897 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
898 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
899
900 Example:
901 global
902 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
903
904 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
905 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
906
907h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
908 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
909 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
910 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
911 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
912 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
913 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
914 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
915 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
916
917 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
918 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
919 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
920
921 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
922 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
923
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100924insecure-fork-wanted
925 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
926 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
927 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
928 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
929 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
930 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
931 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
932 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
933 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
934 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
935 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
936 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
937 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
938 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
939 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
940 disable it.
941
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100942insecure-setuid-wanted
943 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
944 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
945 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
946 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
947 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
948 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
949 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
950 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
951 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
952 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
953 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
954 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
955 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
956 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
957
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100958issuers-chain-path <dir>
959 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
960 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
961 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
962 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
963 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
964 "issuers-chain-path".
965 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
966 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
967 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
968 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
969 will share the chain in memory.
970
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200971log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
972 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100973 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100974 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100975 configured with "log global".
976
977 <address> can be one of:
978
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100979 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100980 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
981 port).
982
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100983 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
984 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
985 port).
986
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100987 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100988 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
989 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100990 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100991
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100992 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
993 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
994 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
995 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
996 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
997 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
998 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
999 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1000 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1001 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1002 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1003 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1004 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1005 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001006 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1007 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001008
1009 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1010 "fd@2", see above.
1011
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001012 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1013 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1014 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1015 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1016 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1017
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001018 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1019 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001020
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001021 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1022 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1023 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1024 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1025 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1026 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1027 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1028 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1029 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1030 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001031 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1032 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001033
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001034 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1035 one of the following :
1036
1037 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
1038 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1039
1040 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1041 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1042
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001043 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1044 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1045 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1046 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1047 logger consumes.
1048
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001049 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1050 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1051 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1052 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1053
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001054 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1055 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1056 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1057 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1058 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1059
1060 <sample_size>
1061 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1062 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1063 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1064 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1065 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1066
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001067 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001068
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001069 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1070 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1071 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1072
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001073 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1074 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1075 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1076 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001077
1078 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001079 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1080 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1081 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1082 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1083 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1084 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001085
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001086 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001087
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001088log-send-hostname [<string>]
1089 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1090 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1091 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1092 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1093 the logs.
1094
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001095log-tag <string>
1096 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1097 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1098 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001099 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001100
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001101lua-load <file>
1102 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1103 used multiple times.
1104
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001105lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1106 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1107 variable.
1108 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1109 to "path".
1110
1111 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1112 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1113 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1114 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1115 will be checked earlier.
1116
1117 As an example by specifying the following path:
1118
1119 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1120 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1121
1122 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1123 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1124 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1125 paths if that does not exist either.
1126
1127 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1128 documentation.
1129
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001130master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001131 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1132 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1133 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001134 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001135 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1136 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001137 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1138 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1139 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1140 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1141 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001142
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001143 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001144
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001145mworker-max-reloads <number>
1146 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001147 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001148 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1149 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1150 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1151
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001152nbproc <number>
1153 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1154 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1155 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001156 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1157 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001158 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1159 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001160
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001161nbthread <number>
1162 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001163 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1164 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1165 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1166 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1167 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001168 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1169 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1170 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1171 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1172 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1173 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1174 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001175
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001176pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001177 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001178 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1179 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1180
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001181presetenv <name> <value>
1182 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1183 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1184 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1185 and "unsetenv".
1186
1187resetenv [<name> ...]
1188 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1189 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1190 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1191 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1192 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1193 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1194 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1195 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1196
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001197stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001198 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1199 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1200 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1201 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1202 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1203 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001204 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001205 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1206 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1207 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1208 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001209
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001210server-state-base <directory>
1211 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001212 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1213 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001214
1215server-state-file <file>
1216 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1217 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1218 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1219 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1220 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1221 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1222 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1223 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001224 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1225 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001226
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001227setenv <name> <value>
1228 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1229 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1230 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1231 and "unsetenv".
1232
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001233set-dumpable
1234 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001235 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1236 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1237 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1238 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1239 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1240 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1241 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1242 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1243 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1244 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1245 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1246 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1247 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1248 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1249 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1250 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1251 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001252
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001253ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1254 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1255 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001256 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001257 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001258 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1259 information and recommendations see e.g.
1260 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1261 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1262 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1263 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001264
1265ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1266 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1267 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1268 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1269 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1270 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001271 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1272 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1273 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001274 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001275
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001276ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1277 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1278 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1279 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1280 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1281 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1282
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001283ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1284 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1285 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1286 keyword to see available options.
1287
1288 Example:
1289 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001290 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001291
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001292ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1293 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1294 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001295 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001296 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001297 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1298 information and recommendations see e.g.
1299 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1300 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1301 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1302 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1303 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001304
1305ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1306 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1307 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1308 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1309 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1310 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001311 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1312 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1313 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1314 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001315
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001316ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1317 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1318 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1319 keyword to see available options.
1320
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001321ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1322 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1323 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1324 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001325 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001326 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001327 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1328 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1329 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1330 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001331 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1332 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1333 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1334
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001335ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001336 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
1337 the loading of the SSL certificates.
1338
1339 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1340 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1341 optimize the startup time.
1342
1343 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1344 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1345 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1346
1347 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001348 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001349
1350 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
1351 will try to load a certificate bundle. This is done by looking for
1352 <basename>.rsa, .ecdsa and .dsa. In the case of directories, HAProxy will
1353 try to gather the files with the same basename in a multi-certificate bundle.
1354 The bundles were introduced with OpenSSL 1.0.2 and were the only way back
1355 then to load an ECDSA certificate and a RSA one, with the same SNI. Since
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001356 OpenSSL 1.1.1 it is not recommended anymore, you can specify both the ECDSA
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001357 and the RSA file on the bind line.
1358
1359 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1360
1361 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1362
1363 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1364 not provided in the PEM file.
1365
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001366 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1367 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1368
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001369 The default behavior is "all".
1370
1371 Example:
1372 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1373 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1374 ssl-load-extra-files none
1375
1376 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1377
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001378ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1379 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1380 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1381 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1382
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001383ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
1384 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the enchor for chain validation: as a
1385 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1386 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1387 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1388 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1389 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1390 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
1391 bits does not need it.
1392
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001393stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1394 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1395 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1396 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001397 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001398 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001399
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001400 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1401 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1402 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001403
1404stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1405 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1406 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001407 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001408
1409stats maxconn <connections>
1410 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1411 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1412
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001413uid <number>
1414 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1415 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1416 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1417 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1418
1419ulimit-n <number>
1420 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1421 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1422 option.
1423
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001424unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1425 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1426
1427 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1428 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1429 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1430 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1431 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1432 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1433 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1434 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1435 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1436 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1437
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001438unsetenv [<name> ...]
1439 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1440 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1441 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1442 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1443 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1444 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1445 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1446
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001447user <user name>
1448 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1449 See also "uid" and "group".
1450
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001451node <name>
1452 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1453
1454 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1455 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1456 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1457 traffic.
1458
1459description <text>
1460 Add a text that describes the instance.
1461
1462 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1463 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1464 "<" and ">" characters.
1465
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100146651degrees-data-file <file path>
1467 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001468 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001469
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001470 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001471 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1472
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000147351degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001474 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1475 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1476 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1477
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001478 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001479 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1480
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200148151degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001482 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1483 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1484
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001485 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1486 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1487
148851degrees-cache-size <number>
1489 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1490 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1491 By default, this cache is disabled.
1492
1493 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001494 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1495
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001496wurfl-data-file <file path>
1497 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1498 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1499
1500 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1501 with USE_WURFL=1.
1502
1503wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1504 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1505 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1506 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1507
1508 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1509
1510 Valid WURFL properties are:
1511 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1512
1513 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1514 device.
1515
1516 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1517 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1518
1519 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1520 particular web request.
1521
1522 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1523 used Libwurfl API version.
1524
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001525 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1526 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1527
1528 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1529 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1530
1531 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1532
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001533 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1534 with USE_WURFL=1.
1535
1536wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1537 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1538 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1539
1540 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1541 with USE_WURFL=1.
1542
1543wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1544 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1545 thus before the chroot.
1546
1547 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1548 with USE_WURFL=1.
1549
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001550wurfl-cache-size <size>
1551 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1552 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001553 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001554 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001555
1556 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1557 with USE_WURFL=1.
1558
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001559strict-limits
1560 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy is tries to set
1561 the best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it
1562 will emit a warning. Use this option if you want an explicit failure of
1563 haproxy when those limits fail. This option is disabled by default. If it has
1564 been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no"
1565 keyword.
1566
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015673.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001568-----------------------
1569
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001570busy-polling
1571 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1572 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1573 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1574 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1575 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1576 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1577 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1578 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1579 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1580 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1581 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1582 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1583 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1584 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1585 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1586 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1587 "poll" pollers.
1588
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001589 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1590 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1591 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1592
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001593max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1594 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1595 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1596 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1597 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1598 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1599 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1600 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1601 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1602
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001603maxconn <number>
1604 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1605 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1606 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001607 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1608 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1609 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1610 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001611 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1612 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1613 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1614 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1615 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1616 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001617
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001618maxconnrate <number>
1619 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1620 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1621 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1622 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1623 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1624 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1625 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1626 fairness.
1627
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001628maxcomprate <number>
1629 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001630 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001631 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1632 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1633 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001634 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001635 default value.
1636
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001637maxcompcpuusage <number>
1638 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1639 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1640 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1641 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1642 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1643 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1644 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1645 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1646
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001647maxpipes <number>
1648 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1649 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1650 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1651 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1652 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1653 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1654
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001655maxsessrate <number>
1656 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1657 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1658 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1659 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1660 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1661 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1662 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1663 fairness.
1664
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001665maxsslconn <number>
1666 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1667 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1668 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1669 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1670 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1671 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1672 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001673 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1674 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1675 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1676 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1677 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1678 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1679 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001680
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001681maxsslrate <number>
1682 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1683 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1684 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1685 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1686 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1687 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1688 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1689 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1690 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1691 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1692
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001693maxzlibmem <number>
1694 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1695 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1696 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001697 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1698 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1699 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1700
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001701noepoll
1702 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1703 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001704 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001705
1706nokqueue
1707 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1708 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1709 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1710
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001711noevports
1712 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1713 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1714 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1715 also "nopoll".
1716
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001717nopoll
1718 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1719 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001720 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001721 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1722 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001723
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001724nosplice
1725 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001726 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001727 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001728 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001729 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1730 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1731 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1732 "option splice-response".
1733
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001734nogetaddrinfo
1735 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1736 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1737
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001738noreuseport
1739 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1740 command line argument "-dR".
1741
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001742profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1743 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1744 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1745 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1746 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001747 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001748 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1749 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1750 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1751 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1752
1753 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1754 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1755 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1756 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1757 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001758 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1759 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1760 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1761 CLI.
1762
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001763spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001764 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1765 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1766 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1767 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1768 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1769 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001770
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001771ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001772 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001773 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001774 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1775 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1776 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1777 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1778 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001779 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1780 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001781 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1782 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1783 openssl configuration file uses:
1784 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1785
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001786ssl-mode-async
1787 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001788 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001789 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1790 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1791 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001792 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001793 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001794
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001795tune.buffers.limit <number>
1796 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1797 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1798 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1799 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1800 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001801 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001802 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1803 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1804 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1805 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1806 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1807 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1808 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1809 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1810 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1811
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001812tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1813 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1814 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1815 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1816 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1817
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001818tune.bufsize <number>
1819 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1820 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1821 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1822 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1823 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1824 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1825 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001826 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1827 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1828 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001829 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001830 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1831 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1832 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001833
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001834tune.chksize <number>
1835 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1836 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1837 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1838 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1839 checks whenever possible.
1840
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001841tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1842 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1843 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1844 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1845 this value. The default value is 1.
1846
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001847tune.fail-alloc
1848 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1849 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1850 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1851 gracefully.
1852
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001853tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1854 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1855 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1856 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1857 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1858 change it.
1859
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001860tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1861 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001862 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1863 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001864 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1865 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1866 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1867 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1868 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1869
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001870tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1871 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1872 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1873 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1874 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1875 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1876 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1877 recommended not to change this value.
1878
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001879tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1880 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1881 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1882 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1883 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1884 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1885 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1886 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1887
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001888tune.http.cookielen <number>
1889 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1890 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1891 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1892 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1893 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1894 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1895 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1896 to change this value.
1897
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001898tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001899 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1900 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001901 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001902 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001903 configuration directives too.
1904 The default value is 1024.
1905
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001906tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1907 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1908 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1909 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1910 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1911 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1912 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001913 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1914 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1915 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001916
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001917tune.idletimer <timeout>
1918 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1919 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1920 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1921 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1922 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1923 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001924 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001925 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001926 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1927
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001928tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1929 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1930 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1931 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1932 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1933 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1934 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1935 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1936 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1937 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1938
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001939tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1940 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001941 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001942 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1943 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001944 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001945 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1946 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1947
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001948tune.lua.maxmem
1949 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1950 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1951 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1952 memory.
1953
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001954tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1955 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001956 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1957 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001958 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001959
1960tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1961 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1962 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1963 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1964 check servers.
1965
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001966tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1967 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1968 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1969 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001970 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001971
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001972tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001973 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1974 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1975 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1976 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1977 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1978 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1979 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1980 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1981 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1982 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001983
1984tune.maxpollevents <number>
1985 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1986 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1987 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1988 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1989 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1990
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001991tune.maxrewrite <number>
1992 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1993 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1994 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1995 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1996 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1997 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1998 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1999 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2000 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2001 bufsize.
2002
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002003tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2004 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2005 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2006 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2007 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2008 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2009 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2010 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2011 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2012 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002013 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2014 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002015 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2016 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2017 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2018 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2019 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2020 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2021 setting this parameter to 0.
2022
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002023tune.pipesize <number>
2024 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2025 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2026 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2027 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2028 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2029 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2030
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002031tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2032 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2033 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2034 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2035 default is 20.
2036
2037tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2038 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2039 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2040 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2041 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2042 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2043 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002044 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002045
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002046tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2047tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2048 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2049 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2050 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002051 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002052 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002053 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2054 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2055
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002056tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002057 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002058 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2059 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2060 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2061 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2062
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002063tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002064 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002065 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
2066 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
2067
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002068tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2069tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2070 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2071 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2072 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002073 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002074 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002075 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2076 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2077 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2078 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2079 notifying haproxy again.
2080
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002081tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002082 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
2083 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
2084 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002085 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002086 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002087 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002088 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
2089 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
2090 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01002091 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
2092 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002093
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002094tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002095 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002096 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2097 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2098 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2099 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2100 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2101
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002102tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2103 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002104 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002105 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2106 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2107 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2108 being used for too long.
2109
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002110tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2111 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2112 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2113 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2114 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2115 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2116 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2117 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2118 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2119 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2120 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002121 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002122 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002123
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002124tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2125 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2126 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2127 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2128 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
2129 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
2130 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2131 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002132 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2133 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002134
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002135tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2136 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2137 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2138 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2139 1000 entries.
2140
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002141tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2142 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2143 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2144 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2145
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002146tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002147tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002148tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2149tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2150tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002151 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2152 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2153 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2154 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2155 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2156 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2157 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2158 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002159
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002160 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2161 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2162 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2163 all available space is consumed.
2164 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2165 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2166 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002167
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002168tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2169 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002170 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002171 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002172 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002173 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2174
2175tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2176 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2177 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002178 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2179 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002180
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021813.3. Debugging
2182--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002183
Willy Tarreau1b857852020-02-25 11:27:22 +01002184debug (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002185 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2186 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2187 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2188 system startup.
2189
2190quiet
2191 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2192 line argument "-q".
2193
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002194zero-warning
2195 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2196 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2197 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2198 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2199 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2200 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2201
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002202
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010022033.4. Userlists
2204--------------
2205It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2206http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2207it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2208
2209userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002210 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002211 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2212
2213group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002214 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002215 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2216 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2217
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002218user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2219 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002220 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2221 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002222 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2223 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2224 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2225 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002226
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002227 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2228 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2229 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2230 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2231 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2232 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2233 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2234 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2235 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002236
2237 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002238 userlist L1
2239 group G1 users tiger,scott
2240 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002241
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002242 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2243 user scott insecure-password elgato
2244 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002245
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002246 userlist L2
2247 group G1
2248 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002249
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002250 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2251 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2252 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002253
2254 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002255
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002256
22573.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002258----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002259It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2260several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2261instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2262values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2263automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2264In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2265using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2266tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2267reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2268Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2269that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2270each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002271
2272peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002273 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002274 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2275
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002276bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2277 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2278 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2279
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002280disabled
2281 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2282 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2283 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2284
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002285default-bind [param*]
2286 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2287
2288default-server [param*]
2289 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2290
2291 Arguments:
2292 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2293 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2294 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2295 details.
2296
2297
2298 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2299
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002300enable
2301 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2302
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002303log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2304 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2305 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2306 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2307 more details.
2308
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002309peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002310 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2311 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2312 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2313 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2314 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2315 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2316
2317 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2318 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2319
2320 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2321 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2322 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2323 across all peers.
2324
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002325 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2326 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002327
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002328 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2329 "server" keyword explanation below).
2330
2331server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002332 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002333 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2334 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2335 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2336 of this "peers" section).
2337 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2338
2339
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002340 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002341 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002342 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002343 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2344 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2345 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002346
2347 backend mybackend
2348 mode tcp
2349 balance roundrobin
2350 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2351 stick on src
2352
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002353 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2354 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002355
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002356 Example:
2357 peers mypeers
2358 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2359 default-server ssl verify none
2360 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2361 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002362
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002363
2364table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2365 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2366
2367 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2368 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002369 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002370 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2371 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2372 "stick-table" keyword).
2373
2374 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2375 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2376 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2377 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2378 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2379 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2380 of the stick-table name as follows:
2381
2382 peers mypeers
2383 peer A ...
2384 peer B ...
2385 table t1 ...
2386
2387 frontend fe1
2388 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2389
2390 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2391 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2392
2393 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2394 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2395 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2396 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2397 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2398 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2399 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2400
2401 peers mypeers
2402 peer A ...
2403 peer B ...
2404 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2405
2406 backend t1
2407 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2408
2409 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2410 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2411 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2412
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090024133.6. Mailers
2414------------
2415It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2416If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2417in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2418
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002419mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002420 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2421 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2422
2423mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2424 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2425
2426 Example:
2427 mailers mymailers
2428 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2429 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2430
2431 backend mybackend
2432 mode tcp
2433 balance roundrobin
2434
2435 email-alert mailers mymailers
2436 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2437 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2438
2439 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2440 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2441
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002442timeout mail <time>
2443 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2444 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2445 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2446 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2447
2448 Example:
2449 mailers mymailers
2450 timeout mail 20s
2451 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002452
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020024533.7. Programs
2454-------------
2455In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2456master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2457managed the same way as the workers.
2458
2459During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2460sequence as a worker:
2461
2462 - the master is re-executed
2463 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2464 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2465 instance of the program
2466
2467During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2468
2469program <name>
2470 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2471 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2472 the management guide).
2473
2474command <command> [arguments*]
2475 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2476 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2477 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2478 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2479
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002480user <user name>
2481 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2482 See also "group".
2483
2484group <group name>
2485 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2486 See also "user".
2487
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002488option start-on-reload
2489no option start-on-reload
2490 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2491 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2492 program section.
2493
2494
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010024953.8. HTTP-errors
2496----------------
2497
2498It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2499imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2500several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2501
2502http-errors <name>
2503 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2504 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2505
2506errorfile <code> <file>
2507 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2508
2509 Arguments :
2510 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2511 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429,
2512 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2513
2514 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2515 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2516 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2517 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2518 before any chroot is performed.
2519
2520 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2521
2522 Example:
2523 http-errors website-1
2524 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2525 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2526 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2527
2528 http-errors website-2
2529 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2530 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2531 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2532
2533
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025344. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002535----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002536
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002537Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002538 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002539 - frontend <name>
2540 - backend <name>
2541 - listen <name>
2542
2543A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2544its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2545section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002546section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002547
2548A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2549connections.
2550
2551A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2552to forward incoming connections.
2553
2554A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2555parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2556
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002557All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2558'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2559case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2560
2561Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2562logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2563proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2564However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2565name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2566
2567Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2568and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002569bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002570protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2571modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2572arbitrary criteria.
2573
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002574In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2575a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002576the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002577
2578 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2579 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2580 between responses and new requests.
2581
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002582 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2583 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2584 client-facing connection remains open.
2585
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002586 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2587 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002588
2589The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2590frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2591following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002592weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002593
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002594 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002595
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002596 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2597 ----+-----+-----+----
2598 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2599 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002600 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2601 ----+-----+-----+----
2602 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002603
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002604
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002605
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026064.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2607--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002608
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002609The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2610limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2611they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2612limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002613marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002614option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002615and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2616with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2617specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002618
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002619
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002620 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2621------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2622acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002623backlog X X X -
2624balance X - X X
2625bind - X X -
2626bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002627capture cookie - X X -
2628capture request header - X X -
2629capture response header - X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002630compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002631cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002632declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002633default-server X - X X
2634default_backend X X X -
2635description - X X X
2636disabled X X X X
2637dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002638email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002639email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002640email-alert mailers X X X X
2641email-alert myhostname X X X X
2642email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002643enabled X X X X
2644errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002645errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002646errorloc X X X X
2647errorloc302 X X X X
2648-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2649errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002650force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002651filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002652fullconn X - X X
2653grace X X X X
2654hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01002655http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02002656http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002657http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002658http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002659http-check expect X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002660http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002661http-check set-var X - X X
2662http-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002663http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002664http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002665http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002666http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002667id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002668ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002669load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002670log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002671log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002672log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002673log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002674max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002675maxconn X X X -
2676mode X X X X
2677monitor fail - X X -
2678monitor-net X X X -
2679monitor-uri X X X -
2680option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2681option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2682option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2683option allbackups (*) X - X X
2684option checkcache (*) X - X X
2685option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2686option contstats (*) X X X -
2687option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2688option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002689-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2690option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002691option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2692option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002693option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002694option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002695option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002696option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002697option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002698option http-server-close (*) X X X X
2699option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2700option httpchk X - X X
2701option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002702option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002703option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002704option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002705option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002706option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002707option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2708option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2709option logasap (*) X X X -
2710option mysql-check X - X X
2711option nolinger (*) X X X X
2712option originalto X X X X
2713option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002714option pgsql-check X - X X
2715option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002716option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002717option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002718option smtpchk X - X X
2719option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2720option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2721option splice-request (*) X X X X
2722option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002723option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002724option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2725option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2726-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002727option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002728option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2729option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2730option tcpka X X X X
2731option tcplog X X X X
2732option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002733external-check command X - X X
2734external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002735persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2736rate-limit sessions X X X -
2737redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002738-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002739retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002740retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002741server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002742server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002743server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002744source X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002745stats admin - X X X
2746stats auth X X X X
2747stats enable X X X X
2748stats hide-version X X X X
2749stats http-request - X X X
2750stats realm X X X X
2751stats refresh X X X X
2752stats scope X X X X
2753stats show-desc X X X X
2754stats show-legends X X X X
2755stats show-node X X X X
2756stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002757-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2758stick match - - X X
2759stick on - - X X
2760stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002761stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002762stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02002763tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02002764tcp-check connect X - X X
2765tcp-check expect X - X X
2766tcp-check send X - X X
2767tcp-check send-binary X - X X
2768tcp-check set-var X - X X
2769tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002770tcp-request connection - X X -
2771tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002772tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002773tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002774tcp-response content - - X X
2775tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002776timeout check X - X X
2777timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002778timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002779timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002780timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2781timeout http-request X X X X
2782timeout queue X - X X
2783timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002784timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002785timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002786timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002787transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002788unique-id-format X X X -
2789unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002790use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002791use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002792use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002793------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2794 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002795
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002796
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020027974.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2798---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002799
2800This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2801
2802
2803acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2804 Declare or complete an access list.
2805 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2806 no | yes | yes | yes
2807 Example:
2808 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2809 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2810 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2811
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002812 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002813
2814
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002815backlog <conns>
2816 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2817 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2818 yes | yes | yes | no
2819 Arguments :
2820 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2821 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002822 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002823
2824 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2825 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2826 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2827 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2828 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2829 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2830 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2831 backlog parameter.
2832
2833 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2834 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2835 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2836
2837 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2838
2839
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002840balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002841balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002842 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2843 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2844 yes | no | yes | yes
2845 Arguments :
2846 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2847 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2848 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2849 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2850
2851 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2852 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2853 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2854 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002855 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002856 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002857 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2858 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2859 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2860 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2861 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2862 it, so that you don't worry.
2863
2864 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2865 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2866 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2867 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2868 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2869 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2870 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2871 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002872
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002873 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2874 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2875 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2876 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2877 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2878 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2879 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2880 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2881
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002882 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002883 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002884 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2885 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002886 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002887 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2888 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2889 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2890 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2891 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002892 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2893 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2894 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2895 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2896 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2897 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002898
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002899 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2900 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2901 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2902 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2903 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2904 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2905 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2906 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002907 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002908 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002909 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2910 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2911 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002912
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002913 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2914 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2915 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2916 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2917 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2918 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2919 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2920 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2921 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2922 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2923 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2924 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002925
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002926 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002927 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2928 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2929 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2930 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2931 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2932 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2933 URIs start with a leading "/".
2934
2935 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2936 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2937 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2938 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2939
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002940 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002941 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2942
2943 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002944 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2945 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002946 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2947 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2948 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2949 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002950 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002951 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2952 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002953
2954 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2955 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2956 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2957 server will receive the request.
2958
2959 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2960 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2961 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2962 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2963 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002964 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2965 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2966 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002967
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002968 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2969 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2970 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2971 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2972 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002973
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002974 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002975 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2976 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2977 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2978
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002979 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2980 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2981 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2982
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002983 random
2984 random(<draws>)
2985 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002986 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2987 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2988 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2989 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002990 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2991 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2992 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2993 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2994 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2995 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2996 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2997 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2998 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2999 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3000 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3001 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3002 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3003 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3004 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3005 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3006 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3007 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3008 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3009 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003010
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003011 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003012 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003013 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3014 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3015 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3016 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3017 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3018 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003019 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003020 used instead.
3021
3022 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3023 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3024 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3025 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3026
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003027 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3028 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3029 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3030
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003031 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003032
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003033 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003034 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3035 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003036
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003037 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3038 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3039 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003040
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003041 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003042 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003043 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3044 NTLM relies on.
3045
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003046 Examples :
3047 balance roundrobin
3048 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003049 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003050 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3051 balance hdr(host)
3052 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003053
3054 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3055 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3056
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003057 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003058 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3059 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3060 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003061 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003062
3063 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3064 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3065 defaults to 16 kB.
3066
3067 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3068 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3069
3070 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3071 Round Robin.
3072
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003073 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003074 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3075 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3076 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3077
3078 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3079
3080 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003081 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003082 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3083 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3084 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003085
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003086 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003087
3088
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003089bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3090bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003091 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3092 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3093 no | yes | yes | no
3094 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003095 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3096 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3097 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3098 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003099 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003100 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3101 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3102 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3103 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3104 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3105 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
3106 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003107 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3108 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3109 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3110 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3111 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3112 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3113 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003114 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3115 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3116 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003117 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3118 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3119 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3120 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003121 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3122 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3123 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003124
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003125 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3126 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003127 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3128 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3129 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003130 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3131 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3132 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3133 the range.
3134
3135 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3136 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3137 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3138 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3139 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3140 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3141 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003142 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003143 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003144
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003145 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003146 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003147 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3148 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3149 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3150 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3151 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3152 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3153
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003154 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3155 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3156 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3157 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003158
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003159 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3160 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3161 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3162 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3163 in a frontend.
3164
3165 Example :
3166 listen http_proxy
3167 bind :80,:443
3168 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003169 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003170
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003171 listen http_https_proxy
3172 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003173 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003174
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003175 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3176 bind ipv6@:80
3177 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3178 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3179
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003180 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003181 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003182
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003183 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3184 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3185 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3186 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3187 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3188
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003189 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003190 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003191
3192
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003193bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003194 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3195 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3196 yes | yes | yes | yes
3197 Arguments :
3198 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3199 may be used to override a default value.
3200
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003201 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003202 option may be combined with other numbers.
3203
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003204 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003205 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3206 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3207 missing from all processes.
3208
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003209 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003210 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003211 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3212 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3213 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3214 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3215 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003216 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003217
3218 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3219 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3220 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3221 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3222 and 'even' instances.
3223
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003224 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3225 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3226 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3227 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003228
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003229 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3230 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3231
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003232 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3233 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3234 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3235
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003236 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3237 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3238
3239 Example :
3240 listen app_ip1
3241 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003242 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003243
3244 listen app_ip2
3245 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003246 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003247
3248 listen management
3249 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003250 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003251
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003252 listen management
3253 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3254 bind-process 1-4
3255
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003256 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003257
3258
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003259capture cookie <name> len <length>
3260 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3261 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3262 no | yes | yes | no
3263 Arguments :
3264 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3265 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3266 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3267 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003268 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003269
3270 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3271 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3272 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3273 right if it exceeds <length>.
3274
3275 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3276 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3277 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3278 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3279
3280 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3281 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3282 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3283
3284 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3285 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3286 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003287 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3288 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3289 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003290
3291 Example:
3292 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3293
3294 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003295 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003296
3297
3298capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003299 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3301 no | yes | yes | no
3302 Arguments :
3303 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003304 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003305 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3306 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3307 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3308
3309 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3310 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3311 it exceeds <length>.
3312
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003313 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003314 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3315 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003316 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3317 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3318 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3319 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003320 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003321 environments to find where the request came from.
3322
3323 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3324 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3325 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3326 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003327
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003328 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3329 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3330 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3331 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3332 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003333
3334 Example:
3335 capture request header Host len 15
3336 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003337 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003338
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003339 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003340 about logging.
3341
3342
3343capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003344 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3346 no | yes | yes | no
3347 Arguments :
3348 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003349 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003350 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3351 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3352 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3353
3354 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3355 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3356 it exceeds <length>.
3357
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003358 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003359 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3360 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3361 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003362 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3363 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3364 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3365 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003366
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003367 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3368 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3369 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3370 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3371 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003372
3373 Example:
3374 capture response header Content-length len 9
3375 capture response header Location len 15
3376
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003377 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003378 about logging.
3379
3380
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003381compression algo <algorithm> ...
3382compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003383compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003384 Enable HTTP compression.
3385 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3386 yes | yes | yes | yes
3387 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003388 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3389 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3390 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3391
3392 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003393 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3394 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3395 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003396
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003397 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003398 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003399
3400 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3401 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3402 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3403 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3404 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003405 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003406
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003407 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3408 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3409 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3410 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3411 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3412 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3413 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003414 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003415
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003416 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003417 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003418 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3419 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3420 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3421 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3422 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003423
3424 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3425 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3426 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3427 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3428 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003429 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3430 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3431 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3432 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3433 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003434 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3435 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003436
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003437 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003438 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3439 "Accept-Encoding" header
3440 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003441 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003442 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3443 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3444 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3445 "multipart"
3446 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3447 header
3448 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3449 and later
3450 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3451 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003452 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003453
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003454 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003455
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003456 Examples :
3457 compression algo gzip
3458 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003459
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003460
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003461cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003462 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3463 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003464 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003465 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3466 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3467 yes | no | yes | yes
3468 Arguments :
3469 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3470 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3471 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3472 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3473 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3474 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003475 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003476 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3477 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3478
3479 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3480 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3481 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3482 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3483 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3484 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003485 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3486 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003487 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003488 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3489 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003490
3491 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003492 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003493
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003494 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003495 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003496 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003497 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003498 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3499 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3500 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3501 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3502 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3503 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3504 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003505
3506 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3507 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3508 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3509 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3510 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3511 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3512 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3513 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3514 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003515 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003516 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3517 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3518 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003519
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003520 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3521 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3522 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003523 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3524 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3525 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3526 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003527 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3528 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3529 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003530
3531 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3532 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3533 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3534 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3535 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3536 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3537 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3538 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3539 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3540
3541 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3542 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3543 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3544 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3545 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3546 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3547 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3548 persistence cookie in the cache.
3549 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3550
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003551 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3552 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3553 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3554 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3555 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003556 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003557 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3558 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3559 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3560 they logout.
3561
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003562 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3563 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3564 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3565 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3566
3567 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3568 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3569 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3570 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3571 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3572 this attribute.
3573
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003574 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003575 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003576 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3577 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3578 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3579 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3580 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3581 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003582
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003583 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3584 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3585 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3586 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3587 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3588 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3589 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3590 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003591 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003592 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3593 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3594 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3595 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3596 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3597 the site.
3598
3599 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3600 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3601 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3602 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3603 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3604 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3605 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3606 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3607 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3608 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3609 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3610 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3611 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003612 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003613 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3614 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3615
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003616 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3617 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3618 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3619 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3620 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3621 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3622
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003623 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
3624 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
3625 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
3626 repeated.
3627
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003628 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3629 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3630 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3631 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003632
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003633 Examples :
3634 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3635 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3636 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003637 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003638
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003639 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003640
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003641
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003642declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3643 Declares a capture slot.
3644 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3645 no | yes | yes | no
3646 Arguments:
3647 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3648
3649 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3650 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3651 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3652 for use in the response.
3653
3654 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003655 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003656 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3657
3658
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003659default-server [param*]
3660 Change default options for a server in a backend
3661 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3662 yes | no | yes | yes
3663 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003664 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3665 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3666 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3667 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003668
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003669 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003670 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3671
3672 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003673
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003674
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003675default_backend <backend>
3676 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3677 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3678 yes | yes | yes | no
3679 Arguments :
3680 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3681
3682 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3683 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3684 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3685 will catch all undetermined requests.
3686
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003687 Example :
3688
3689 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3690 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3691 default_backend dynamic
3692
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003693 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003694
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003695
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003696description <string>
3697 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3698 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3699 no | yes | yes | yes
3700 Arguments : string
3701
3702 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3703 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3704 it describes.
3705 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3706
3707
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003708disabled
3709 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3710 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3711 yes | yes | yes | yes
3712 Arguments : none
3713
3714 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3715 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3716 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3717 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3718 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3719 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3720 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3721
3722 See also : "enabled"
3723
3724
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003725dispatch <address>:<port>
3726 Set a default server address
3727 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3728 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003729 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003730
3731 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3732 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3733 during start-up.
3734
3735 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3736 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3737 possible with normal servers.
3738
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003739 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003740 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3741 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3742 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3743 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3744
3745 See also : "server"
3746
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003747
3748dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3749 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3750 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3751 yes | no | yes | yes
3752 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3753
3754 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003755 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003756 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3757 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003758 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003759 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003760
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003761enabled
3762 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3764 yes | yes | yes | yes
3765 Arguments : none
3766
3767 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3768 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3769
3770 See also : "disabled"
3771
3772
3773errorfile <code> <file>
3774 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3775 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3776 yes | yes | yes | yes
3777 Arguments :
3778 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003779 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3780 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003781
3782 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003783 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003784 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003785 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3786 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003787
3788 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3789 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3790 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3791
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003792 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3793
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003794 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3795 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3796 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3797 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3798
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003799 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3800 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003801 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003802 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3803 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3804 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3805
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003806 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3807 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3808 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003809 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003810 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3811
3812 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3813
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003814 Example :
3815 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003816 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003817 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3818 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3819
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003820
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003821errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
3822 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
3823 section.
3824 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3825 yes | yes | yes | yes
3826 Arguments :
3827 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
3828
3829 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
3830 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 403,
3831 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
3832
3833 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
3834 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
3835 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
3836 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
3837 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
3838 ones. Fonctionnly, it is exactly the same than declaring all error files by
3839 hand using "errorfile" directives.
3840
3841 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" , "errorloc303" and section
3842 3.8 about http-errors.
3843
3844 Example :
3845 errorfiles generic
3846 errorfiles site-1 403 404
3847
3848
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003849errorloc <code> <url>
3850errorloc302 <code> <url>
3851 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3852 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3853 yes | yes | yes | yes
3854 Arguments :
3855 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003856 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3857 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003858
3859 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3860 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3861 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3862 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003863 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003864
3865 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3866 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3867 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3868
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003869 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3870
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003871 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3872 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3873 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3874 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003875 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003876 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3877 request.
3878
3879 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3880
3881
3882errorloc303 <code> <url>
3883 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3884 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3885 yes | yes | yes | yes
3886 Arguments :
3887 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003888 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3889 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003890
3891 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3892 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3893 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3894 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003895 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003896
3897 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3898 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3899 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3900
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003901 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3902
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003903 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3904 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3905 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3906 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003907 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003908
3909 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3910
3911
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003912email-alert from <emailaddr>
3913 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003914 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003915 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3916 yes | yes | yes | yes
3917
3918 Arguments :
3919
3920 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3921
3922 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3923 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3924
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003925 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003926 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3927 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003928
3929
3930email-alert level <level>
3931 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3932 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3933 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3934 yes | yes | yes | yes
3935
3936 Arguments :
3937
3938 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3939 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3940 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3941
3942 By default level is alert
3943
3944 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3945 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3946 for the proxy.
3947
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003948 Alerts are sent when :
3949
3950 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3951 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3952 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3953 is notice or lower
3954 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3955 and a health check status update occurs
3956
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003957 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3958 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003959 section 3.6 about mailers.
3960
3961
3962email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3963 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3964 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3965 yes | yes | yes | yes
3966
3967 Arguments :
3968
3969 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3970
3971 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3972 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3973
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003974 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3975 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003976
3977
3978email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3979 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3980 mailers.
3981 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3982 yes | yes | yes | yes
3983
3984 Arguments :
3985
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003986 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003987
3988 By default the systems hostname is used.
3989
3990 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3991 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3992 for the proxy.
3993
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003994 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3995 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003996
3997
3998email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003999 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004000 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4001 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4002 yes | yes | yes | yes
4003
4004 Arguments :
4005
4006 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4007
4008 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4009 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4010
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004011 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004012 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4013
4014
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004015force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4016 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4017 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004018 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004019
4020 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4021 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4022 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4023 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4024 marked down for maintenance operations.
4025
4026 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4027 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4028 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4029 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4030 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4031 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4032 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4033 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4034 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4035
4036 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4037 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4038 is used.
4039
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004040 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004041 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004042
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004043
4044filter <name> [param*]
4045 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4046 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4047 no | yes | yes | yes
4048 Arguments :
4049 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4050 referenced in section 9.
4051
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004052 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004053 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004054 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4055 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004056
4057 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4058 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4059
4060 Example:
4061 listen
4062 bind *:80
4063
4064 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4065 filter compression
4066 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4067
4068 compression algo gzip
4069 compression offload
4070
4071 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4072
4073 See also : section 9.
4074
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004075
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004076fullconn <conns>
4077 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4078 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4079 yes | no | yes | yes
4080 Arguments :
4081 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4082 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4083
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004084 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004085 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004086 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004087 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4088 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4089 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4090 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4091 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004092 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004093
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004094 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4095 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004096 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4097 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4098 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004099
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004100 Example :
4101 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4102 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4103 # connections.
4104 backend dynamic
4105 fullconn 10000
4106 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4107 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4108
4109 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4110
4111
4112grace <time>
4113 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004115 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004116 Arguments :
4117 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4118 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4119 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4120
4121 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4122 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004123 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004124 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4125
4126 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4127 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4128 simplify it.
4129
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004130
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004131hash-balance-factor <factor>
4132 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4133 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4134 yes | no | no | yes
4135 Arguments :
4136 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4137 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004138 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004139
4140 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4141 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4142 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4143 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4144 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4145 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4146 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4147
4148 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4149 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4150 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4151 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4152 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4153
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004154 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4155 consistent hashing mechanism.
4156
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004157 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4158
4159
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004160hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004161 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4162 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4163 yes | no | yes | yes
4164 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004165 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4166 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004167
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004168 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4169 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4170 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4171 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4172 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4173 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4174 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4175 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4176 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4177 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004178
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004179 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4180 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4181 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4182 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4183 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4184 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4185 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4186 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4187 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4188 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4189 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4190 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4191 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004192 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4193 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004194
4195 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4196
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004197 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004198 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4199 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4200 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004201 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4202 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4203 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004204
4205 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4206 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004207 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4208 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4209 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4210 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4211
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004212 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4213 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4214 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4215 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4216 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4217 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4218 parameter.
4219
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004220 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4221 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4222 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4223 used on strings.
4224
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004225 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4226
4227 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4228 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4229 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4230 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4231 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4232 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4233 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4234 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4235 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4236 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4237 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4238 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004239
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004240 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4241 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4242 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004243
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004244 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004245
4246
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004247http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4248 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
4249 ones).
4250
4251 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4252 no | yes | yes | yes
4253
4254 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
4255 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
4256 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4257 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4258 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4259 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4260
4261 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
4262 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
4263 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
4264
4265 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4266 below.
4267
4268 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
4269 instance.
4270
4271 Example:
4272 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
4273 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
4274 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
4275
4276http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4277
4278 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4279 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4280 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4281 example, or to pass some internal information.
4282 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4283 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4284 the resulting header from a previous rule.
4285
4286http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4287
4288 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4289 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
4290
4291http-after-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4292
4293 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
4294
4295http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4296 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4297
4298 This works like "http-response replace-header".
4299
4300 Example:
4301 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4302
4303 # applied to:
4304 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4305
4306 # outputs:
4307 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4308
4309 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4310
4311http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4312 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4313
4314 This works like "http-response replace-value".
4315
4316 Example:
4317 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4318
4319 # applied to:
4320 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4321
4322 # outputs:
4323 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4324
4325http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4326
4327 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4328 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4329 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
4330
4331http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4332 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4333
4334 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4335 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4336 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4337 fallback.
4338
4339 Example:
4340 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4341 http-response set-status 431
4342 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4343 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
4344
4345http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4346
4347 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4348 inline.
4349
4350 Arguments:
4351 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4352 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4353 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4354 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4355 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4356 (request and response)
4357 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4358 processing
4359 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4360 processing
4361 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4362 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4363 and '_'.
4364
4365 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4366 followed by some converters.
4367
4368 Example:
4369 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4370
4371http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
4372
4373 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
4374 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
4375 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
4376 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
4377 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004378 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004379 processing.
4380
4381 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
4382 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
4383 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
4384 rules evaluation.
4385
4386http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4387
4388 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
4389 details about <var-name>.
4390
4391 Example:
4392 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4393
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004394
4395http-check comment <string>
4396 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
4397 it fails.
4398 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4399 yes | no | yes | yes
4400
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004401 Arguments :
4402 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
4403 rule fails.
4404
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004405 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
4406 user-friendly error reporting.
4407
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004408 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check conncet", "http-check send" and
4409 "http-check expect".
4410
4411
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004412http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
4413 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02004414 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004415 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
4416 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4417 yes | no | yes | yes
4418
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004419 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004420 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4421
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004422 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
4423 checks. The server options are used only if not redifined.
4424
4425 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
4426 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
4427 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
4428 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
4429
4430 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
4431
4432 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
4433
4434 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
4435
4436 ssl opens a ciphered connection
4437
4438 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
4439
4440 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
4441 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
4442 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
4443 is used.
4444
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02004445 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
4446 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
4447 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
4448 haproxy -vv.
4449
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004450 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
4451
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004452 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
4453 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
4454 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
4455 different ports or with different servers.
4456
4457 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
4458 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
4459 the port with a "http-check connect".
4460
4461 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
4462 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
4463 do.
4464
4465 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
4466 unset-var or comment rules.
4467
4468 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004469 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
4470 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
4471 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
4472 option httpchk
4473
4474 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02004475 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004476 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004477 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02004478 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004479 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004480
4481 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
4482
4483 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004484
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004485
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004486http-check disable-on-404
4487 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4488 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004489 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004490 Arguments : none
4491
4492 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4493 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4494 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4495 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4496 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4497 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4498 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4499 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004500 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4501 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4502 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4503
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004504 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004505
4506
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004507http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004508 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
4509 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
4510 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004511 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004512 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004513 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004514
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004515 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004516 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4517
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004518 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
4519 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
4520 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
4521 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
4522 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
4523 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
4524 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
4525 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
4526 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
4527 result is always conclusive.
4528
4529 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4530 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
4531 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
4532 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported and may be used to set,
4533 respectively, HCHK_STATUS_L7OK, HCHK_STATUS_L7OKCD,
4534 HCHK_STATUS_L6OK or HCHK_STATUS_L4OK success status.
4535 By default "L7OK" is used.
4536
4537 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4538 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
4539 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported and
4540 may be used to set, respectively, HCHK_STATUS_L7RSP,
4541 HCHK_STATUS_L7STS, HCHK_STATUS_L6RSP or HCHK_STATUS_L4CON
4542 error status. By default "L7RSP" is used.
4543
4544 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4545 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
4546 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported and may
4547 be used to set, respectively, HCHK_STATUS_L7TOUT,
4548 HCHK_STATUS_L6TOUT or HCHK_STATUS_L4TOUT timeout status.
4549 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
4550
4551 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
4552 informational message reported in logs if the expect
4553 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
4554 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
4555
4556 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
4557 informational message reported in logs if an error
4558 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
4559 log-format string.
4560
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004561 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
4562 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004563 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004564 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4565 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4566 details on the supported keywords.
4567
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004568 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
4569 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
4570 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
4571 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004572
4573 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4574 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4575 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4576 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4577 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4578
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004579 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
4580 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
4581 codes. A health check response will be considered as
4582 valid if the response's status code matches any status
4583 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
4584 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4585 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004586
4587 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004588 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004589 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4590 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4591 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4592 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4593
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004594 header name [ -m <meth> ] <name> [log-format]
4595 [ value [ -m <meth> ] <value> [log-format] [full] ] :
4596 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
4597 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
4598 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
4599 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
4600 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
4601 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
4602 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
4603 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
4604 method is used. If the "log-format" option is used, the
4605 pattern (<name> or <value>) is evaluated as a log-format
4606 string. This option cannot be used with the regex
4607 matching method. Finally, by default, the header value is
4608 considered as comma-separated list. Each part may be
4609 tested. The "full" option may be used to test the full
4610 header line. Note that matchings are case insensitive on
4611 the header names.
4612
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004613 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004614 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004615 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4616 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4617 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4618 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4619 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004620 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004621 trace).
4622
4623 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004624 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004625 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4626 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4627 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4628 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4629 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004630 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004631
4632 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4633 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4634 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4635 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4636 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4637 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4638 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4639 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4640
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004641 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
4642 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
4643 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
4644 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
4645 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004646
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004647 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4648 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4649
4650 Examples :
4651 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004652 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004653
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004654 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
4655 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
4656
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004657 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004658 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004659
4660 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004661 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004662
4663 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004664 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004665
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004666 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004667 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004668
4669
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02004670http-check send [meth <method>] [uri <uri>] [ver <version>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004671 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [body <string>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004672 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
4673 health checks.
4674 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4675 yes | no | yes | yes
4676 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004677 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4678
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004679 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
4680 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
4681 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
4682 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
4683 to invent non-standard ones.
4684
4685 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests.
4686 it defaults to " / " which is accessible by default on almost
4687 any server, but may be changed to any other URI. Query
4688 strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004689
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02004690 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004691 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
4692 1.0, so turningit to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
4693 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
4694 to add it.
4695
4696 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4697 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
4698 to the log-format rules.
4699
4700 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
4701 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
4702 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004703
4704 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
4705 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
4706 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02004707 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
4708 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
4709 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
4710 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004711 deprecated. Note also the "Connection: close" header is still added if a
4712 "http-check expect" direcive is defined independently of this directive, just
4713 like the state header if the directive "http-check send-state" is defined.
4714
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004715 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4716 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02004717 header should not be present in the request provided by "http-check send". If
4718 so, it will be ignored.
4719
4720 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
4721 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
4722 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
4723 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
4724 configured request authority.
4725
4726 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
4727 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004728
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004729 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004730
4731
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004732http-check send-state
4733 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4734 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4735 yes | no | yes | yes
4736 Arguments : none
4737
4738 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4739 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4740 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4741 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4742 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4743
4744 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4745 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4746 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4747 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4748 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004749 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4750 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4751 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4752
4753 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4754 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4755 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4756
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004757 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4758 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4759 checked in multiple backends.
4760
4761 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4762 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4763
4764 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4765 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4766 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4767 one fails.
4768
4769 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4770 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4771 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4772
4773 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4774 server's queue.
4775
4776 Example of a header received by the application server :
4777 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4778 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4779
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004780 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
4781 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004782
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004783
4784http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004785 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004786 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4787 yes | no | yes | yes
4788
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004789 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004790 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4791 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
4792 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
4793 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
4794 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
4795 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4796 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
4797 and '-'.
4798
4799 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
4800
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004801 Examples :
4802 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004803
4804
4805http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004806 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004807 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4808 yes | no | yes | yes
4809
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004810 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004811 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4812 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
4813 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
4814 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
4815 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
4816 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4817 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
4818 and '-'.
4819
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004820 Examples :
4821 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004822
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004823
4824http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004825 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4826
4827 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4828 no | yes | yes | yes
4829
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004830 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4831 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4832 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4833 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4834 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004835
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004836 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4837 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004838
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004839 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004840
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004841 Example:
4842 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4843 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4844 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004845
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004846 http-request allow if nagios
4847 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4848 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4849 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004850
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004851 Example:
4852 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4853 acl add path /addacl
4854 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004855
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004856 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004857
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004858 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4859 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004860
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004861 Example:
4862 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4863 acl setmap path /setmap
4864 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004865
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004866 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004867
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004868 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4869 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004870
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004871 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4872 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004873
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004874http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004875
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004876 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4877 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4878 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4879 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4880 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4881 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4882 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4883 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004884
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004885http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004886
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004887 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4888 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4889 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4890 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4891 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4892 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4893 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4894 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004895
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004896http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004897
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004898 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4899 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004900
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004901
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004902http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004903
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004904 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4905 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4906 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4907 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4908 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004909
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004910 Example:
4911 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4912 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004913
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004914http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004915
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004916 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004917
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004918http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4919 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004920
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004921 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4922 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4923 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4924 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4925 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4926 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4927 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4928 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4929 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004930
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004931 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4932 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4933 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01004934 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
4935
4936 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
4937 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
4938 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
4939 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004940
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004941http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004942
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004943 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4944 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4945 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4946 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4947 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4948 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004949
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004950http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004951
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004952 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004953
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004954http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004955
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004956 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4957 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4958 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4959 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4960 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4961 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004962
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01004963http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
4964 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004965
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004966 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4967 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4968 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01004969 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive. A specific error
4970 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
4971 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
4972 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
4973 followed by the section name.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004974 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004975
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02004976http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4977 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
4978 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
4979 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
4980
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004981http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4982
4983 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4984 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4985 pointed by <resolvers>.
4986 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4987 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4988 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4989 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4990 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4991 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4992 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4993 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4994 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4995 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4996 to 0.0.0.0.
4997
4998 Example:
4999 resolvers mydns
5000 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
5001 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
5002 timeout retry 1s
5003 hold valid 10s
5004 hold nx 3s
5005 hold other 3s
5006 hold obsolete 0s
5007 accepted_payload_size 8192
5008
5009 frontend fe
5010 bind 10.42.0.1:80
5011 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
5012 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
5013
5014 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
5015 # which mean DNS resolution error
5016 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
5017
5018 default_backend be
5019
5020 backend b_503
5021 # dummy backend used to return 503.
5022 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
5023 # 503 error page to end users
5024
5025 backend be
5026 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
5027 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
5028 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
5029 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
5030 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
5031
5032 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
5033 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
5034
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005035http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5036
5037 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
5038 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
5039 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
5040 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01005041 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
5042 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005043
5044 See RFC 8297 for more information.
5045
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005046http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005047
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005048 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
5049 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
5050 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
5051 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
5052 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005053
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005054http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005055
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005056 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
5057 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
5058 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
5059 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005060
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005061http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5062 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02005063
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005064 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005065 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
5066 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
5067 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
5068 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
5069 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02005070
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005071 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
5072 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
5073 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
5074 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
5075 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005076
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005077 Example:
5078 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
5079
5080 # applied to:
5081 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5082
5083 # outputs:
5084 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5085
5086 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005087
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005088 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
5089
5090 # applied to:
5091 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005092
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005093 # outputs:
5094 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005095
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005096http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5097 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5098
5099 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
5100 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
5101 after an optional scheme+authority. It does contain the query string if any
5102 is present. The replacement does not modify the scheme nor authority.
5103
5104 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5105 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5106 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
5107
5108 Example:
5109 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5110 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
5111
5112 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
5113 http-request replace-path ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
5114
5115 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
5116 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
5117 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
5118 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
5119
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005120http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5121 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5122
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005123 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
5124 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
5125 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
5126 against.
5127
5128 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5129 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5130 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005131
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005132 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
5133 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
5134 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
5135 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
5136 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
5137 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
5138 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
5139 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
5140 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005141 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
5142 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005143
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005144 Example:
5145 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
5146 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005147
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005148 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5149 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005150
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005151http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5152 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005153
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005154 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
5155 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
5156 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
5157 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005158
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005159 Example:
5160 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005161
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005162 # applied to:
5163 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005164
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005165 # outputs:
5166 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005167
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005168http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5169 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5170 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005171 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005172 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5173
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005174 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005175 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
5176 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
5177 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itselft may
5178 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005179 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005180 are followed to create the response :
5181
5182 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
5183 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
5184 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5185 ignored.
5186
5187 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
5188 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
5189 status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425,
5190 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5191 ignored.
5192
5193 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
5194 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
5195 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
5196 by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
5197 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
5198
5199 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
5200 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
5201 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
5202 must be one of the status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
5203 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument,
5204 if any, is ignored.
5205
5206 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
5207 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
5208 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
5209 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
5210 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
5211 as a raw content.
5212
5213 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
5214 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
5215 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
5216 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
5217 considered as a raw string.
5218
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005219 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
5220 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
5221 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
5222 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
5223
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005224 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
5225 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
5226 reserved to the headers rewritting should also be free.
5227
5228 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5229
5230 Example:
5231 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproy/errorfiles/200.http \
5232 if { path /ping }
5233
5234 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
5235 if { path /favicon.ico }
5236
5237 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
5238 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
5239 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
5240
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005241http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5242http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005243
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005244 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5245 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5246 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005247
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005248http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5249 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005250
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005251 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5252 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5253 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5254 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005255
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005256http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005257
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005258 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
5259 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
5260 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
5261 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
5262 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005263
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005264 Arguments:
5265 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5266 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005267
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005268 Example:
5269 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
5270 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005271
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005272 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
5273 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005274
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005275http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005276
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005277 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
5278 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
5279 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005280
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005281 Arguments:
5282 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5283 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005284
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005285 Example:
5286 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
5287 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005288
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005289 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
5290 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
5291 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005292
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005293http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005294
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005295 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
5296 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
5297 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
5298 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
5299 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005300
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005301 Example:
5302 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
5303 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
5304 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
5305 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
5306 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
5307 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
5308 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
5309 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
5310 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005311
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005312http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005313
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005314 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5315 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5316 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5317 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
5318 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005319
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005320http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5321 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005322
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005323 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5324 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5325 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5326 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5327 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
5328 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
5329 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
5330 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
5331 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005332
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005333http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005334
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005335 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5336 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5337 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5338 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
5339 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
5340 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
5341 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005342
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005343http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005344
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005345 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
5346 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
5347 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005348
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005349http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005350
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005351 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
5352 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
5353 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
5354 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
5355 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
5356 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5357 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5358 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005359
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005360http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005361
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005362 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
5363 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
5364 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
5365 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
5366 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
5367 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005368
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005369 Example :
5370 # prepend the host name before the path
5371 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005372
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005373http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02005374
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005375 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
5376 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
5377 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5378 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
5379 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005380
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005381http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005382
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005383 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
5384 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
5385 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5386 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
5387 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
5388 values have higher priority.
5389 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
5390 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
5391 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
5392 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
5393 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005394
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005395http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005396
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005397 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
5398 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
5399 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
5400 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
5401 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
5402 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
5403 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005404
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005405 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005406
5407 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005408 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
5409 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005410
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005411http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5412 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
5413 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
5414 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005415 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
5416 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005417
5418 Arguments :
5419 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5420 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005421
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005422 See also "option forwardfor".
5423
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005424 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005425 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
5426 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
5427
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005428 # After the masking this will track connections
5429 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
5430 http-request track-sc0 src
5431
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005432 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
5433 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
5434
5435http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5436
5437 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
5438 expression.
5439
5440 Arguments:
5441 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5442 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005443
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005444 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005445 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
5446 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
5447
5448 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
5449 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
5450 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
5451
5452http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5453
5454 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5455 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
5456 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
5457 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
5458 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
5459 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
5460 information from the request.
5461
5462 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5463
5464http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5465
5466 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
5467 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
5468 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
5469 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
5470 path and the query string.
5471 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
5472
5473http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5474
5475 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5476 inline.
5477
5478 Arguments:
5479 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5480 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5481 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5482 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5483 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5484 (request and response)
5485 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5486 processing
5487 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5488 processing
5489 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5490 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
5491 and '_'.
5492
5493 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5494 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005495
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005496 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005497 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005498
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005499http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
5500 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005501
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005502 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5503 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5504 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5505 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5506 agent name must be used.
5507
5508 Arguments:
5509 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
5510
5511 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5512 configuration.
5513
5514http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5515
5516 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5517 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5518 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5519 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5520 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5521 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5522 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5523 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5524 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5525 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5526 action.
5527 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5528 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5529 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5530 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5531 you fully understand how it works.
5532
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005533http-request strict-mode { on | off }
5534
5535 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5536 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5537 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5538 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5539 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005540 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005541 processing.
5542
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01005543 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005544 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
5545 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
5546 rules evaluation.
5547
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005548http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
5549 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005550
5551 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
5552 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
5553 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
5554 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
5555 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
5556 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
5557 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
5558 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
5559 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
5560 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
5561 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005562 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. A specific error
5563 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
5564 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
5565 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
5566 followed by the section name.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005567 See also the "silent-drop" action.
5568
5569http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5570http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5571http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5572
5573 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
5574 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
5575 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
5576 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
5577 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
5578 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5579 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
5580 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
5581 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5582 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
5583 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
5584 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
5585
5586 Arguments :
5587 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
5588 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
5589 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
5590 select which table entry to update the counters.
5591
5592 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
5593 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
5594 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
5595 that table until the session ends.
5596
5597 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
5598 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
5599 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
5600 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
5601 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
5602 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
5603 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
5604 useful information.
5605
5606 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
5607 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
5608 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
5609 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
5610 checks that make use of it.
5611
5612http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5613
5614 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005615
5616 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005617 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005618
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01005619http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5620
5621 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
5622 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
5623 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
5624 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
5625 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
5626 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5627
5628 Arguments :
5629 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
5630
5631 Example:
5632 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
5633
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005634http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005635
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005636 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
5637 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
5638 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005639
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005640
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005641http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005642 Access control for Layer 7 responses
5643
5644 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5645 no | yes | yes | yes
5646
5647 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5648 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5649 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5650 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5651 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5652 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5653
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005654 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5655 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005656
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005657 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005658
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005659 Example:
5660 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005661
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005662 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005663
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005664 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
5665 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005666
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005667 Example:
5668 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005669
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005670 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005671
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005672 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
5673 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005674
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005675 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5676 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005677
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005678http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005679
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005680 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5681 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5682 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5683 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5684 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5685 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5686 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5687 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005688
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005689http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005690
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005691 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5692 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5693 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5694 example, or to pass some internal information.
5695 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5696 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5697 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005698
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005699http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005700
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005701 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5702 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005703
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005704http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005705
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005706 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005707
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005708http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005709
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005710 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5711 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
5712 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
5713 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
5714 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
5715 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
5716 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005717
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005718 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
5719 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
5720 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
5721 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
5722 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005723
5724 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5725 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5726 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5727 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005728
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005729http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005730
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005731 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5732 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5733 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5734 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5735 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5736 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005737
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005738http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005739
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005740 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005741
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005742http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005743
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005744 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5745 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5746 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5747 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5748 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5749 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005750
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005751http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
5752 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005753
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005754 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01005755 and emits an HTTP 502 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
5756 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005757 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive. A specific error
5758 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
5759 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
5760 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
5761 followed by the section name.
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01005762 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005763
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005764http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005765
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005766 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
5767 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
5768 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
5769 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
5770 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
5771 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005772
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005773http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5774 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005775
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005776 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
5777 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005778
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005779 Example:
5780 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02005781
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005782 # applied to:
5783 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005784
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005785 # outputs:
5786 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005787
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005788 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005789
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005790http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5791 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005792
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01005793 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005794 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005795
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005796 Example:
5797 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005798
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005799 # applied to:
5800 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005801
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005802 # outputs:
5803 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005804
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005805http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5806 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5807 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005808 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005809 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5810
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005811 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005812 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
5813 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
5814 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itselft may
5815 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005816 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005817 are followed to create the response :
5818
5819 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
5820 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
5821 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5822 ignored.
5823
5824 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
5825 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
5826 status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425,
5827 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5828 ignored.
5829
5830 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
5831 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
5832 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
5833 by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
5834 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
5835
5836 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
5837 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
5838 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
5839 must be one of the status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
5840 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument,
5841 if any, is ignored.
5842
5843 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
5844 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
5845 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
5846 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
5847 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
5848 as a raw content.
5849
5850 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
5851 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
5852 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
5853 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
5854 considered as a raw string.
5855
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005856 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
5857 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
5858 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
5859 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
5860
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005861 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
5862 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
5863 reserved to the headers rewritting should also be free.
5864
5865 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
5866
5867 Example:
5868 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproy/errorfiles/200.http \
5869 if { status eq 404 }
5870
5871 http-response return content-type text/plain \
5872 string "This is the end !" \
5873 if { status eq 500 }
5874
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005875http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5876http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08005877
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005878 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5879 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5880 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005881
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005882http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5883 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005884
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005885 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5886 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5887 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5888 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005889
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005890http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005891
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005892 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5893 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5894 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5895 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5896 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005897
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005898 Arguments:
5899 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005900
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005901 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5902 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005903
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005904http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005905
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005906 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5907 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5908 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005909
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005910http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5911
5912 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5913 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5914 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5915 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
5916 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
5917
5918http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5919
5920 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5921 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5922 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5923 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5924 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
5925 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5926 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5927 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
5928 be triggered by an HTTP response.
5929
5930http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5931
5932 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5933 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5934 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5935 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
5936 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
5937 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5938 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5939
5940http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5941
5942 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5943 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5944 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5945 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5946 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5947 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5948 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5949 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5950
5951http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5952 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5953
5954 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5955 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5956 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5957 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005958
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005959 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005960 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5961 http-response set-status 431
5962 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5963 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005964
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005965http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005966
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005967 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5968 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5969 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5970 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5971 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5972 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5973 based on some information from the request.
5974
5975 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5976
5977http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5978
5979 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5980 inline.
5981
5982 Arguments:
5983 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5984 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5985 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5986 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5987 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5988 (request and response)
5989 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5990 processing
5991 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5992 processing
5993 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5994 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5995 and '_'.
5996
5997 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5998 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005999
6000 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006001 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006002
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006003http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006004
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006005 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6006 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6007 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6008 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6009 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6010 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6011 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6012 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6013 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6014 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6015 action.
6016 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6017 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6018 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6019 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6020 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006021
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006022http-response strict-mode { on | off }
6023
6024 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6025 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6026 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6027 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6028 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006029 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006030 processing.
6031
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006032 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006033 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6034 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
6035 rules evaluation.
6036
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006037http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6038http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6039http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006040
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006041 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
6042 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
6043 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
6044 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
6045 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
6046 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
6047
6048http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6049
6050 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
6051 about <var-name>.
6052
6053 Example:
6054 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
6055
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02006056
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006057http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
6058 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
6059
6060 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6061 yes | no | yes | yes
6062
6063 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006064 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
6065 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
6066 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006067
6068 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
6069
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006070 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
6071 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
6072 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
6073 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
6074 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
6075 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
6076 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
6077 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
6078 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
6079 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006080
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006081 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
6082 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
6083 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
6084 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
6085 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
6086 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
6087 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
6088 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006089
6090 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
6091 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
6092 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
6093 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
6094 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
6095 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
6096 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
6097 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02006098 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006099 downsides of rare connection failures.
6100
6101 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
6102 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
6103 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
6104 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
6105 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
6106 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006107 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006108 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
6109 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
6110 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
6111 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
6112 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
6113
6114 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006115 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
6116 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
6117 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006118
6119 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006120 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006121
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02006122 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
6123 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006124
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01006125 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006126
6127 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
6128 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
6129 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
6130
6131 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
6132
6133
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006134http-send-name-header [<header>]
6135 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006136 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6137 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006138 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006139 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
6140
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02006141 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
6142 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
6143 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
6144 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
6145 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
6146 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
6147 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
6148 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
6149 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
6150 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
6151 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
6152 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
6153 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
6154 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
6155 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
6156 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006157
6158 See also : "server"
6159
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006160id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006161 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
6162 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6163 no | yes | yes | yes
6164 Arguments : none
6165
6166 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
6167 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
6168 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006169
6170
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006171ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
6172 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
6173 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01006174 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006175
6176 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
6177 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
6178 and running).
6179
6180 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
6181 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
6182 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006183 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006184 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
6185
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006186 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
6187 "unless" condition is met.
6188
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006189 Example:
6190 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
6191 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
6192 ignore-persist if url_static
6193
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006194 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
6195
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006196load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
6197 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
6198 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6199 yes | no | yes | yes
6200
6201 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
6202 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
6203 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006204 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006205 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
6206 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
6207 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
6208 over the stats socket and redirect output.
6209
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006210 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006211 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02006212 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006213
6214 Arguments:
6215 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
6216 named "server-state-file".
6217
6218 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
6219 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
6220 name is used as a file name.
6221
6222 none don't load any stat for this backend
6223
6224 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01006225 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
6226 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
6227 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006228 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01006229 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006230
6231 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
6232 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
6233
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006234 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006235
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006236 global
6237 stats socket /tmp/socket
6238 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006239
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006240 defaults
6241 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006242
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006243 backend bk
6244 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6245 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006246
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006247
6248 Then one can run :
6249
6250 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
6251
6252 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
6253
6254 1
6255 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6256 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6257 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6258
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006259 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006260
6261 global
6262 stats socket /tmp/socket
6263 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
6264
6265 defaults
6266 load-server-state-from-file local
6267
6268 backend bk
6269 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6270 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
6271
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006272
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006273 Then one can run :
6274
6275 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
6276
6277 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
6278
6279 1
6280 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6281 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6282 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6283
6284 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
6285 "show servers state"
6286
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006287
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006288log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006289log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
6290 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006291no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006292 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
6293 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6294 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006295
6296 Prefix :
6297 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
6298 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
6299 prefix does not allow arguments.
6300
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006301 Arguments :
6302 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
6303 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
6304 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
6305 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
6306 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
6307 parameter.
6308
6309 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
6310 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
6311
6312 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
6313 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6314 standard syslog port).
6315
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01006316 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
6317 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6318 standard syslog port).
6319
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006320 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
6321 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
6322 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006323 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006324
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006325 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
6326 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
6327 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
6328 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
6329 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
6330 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
6331 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
6332 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
6333 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
6334 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
6335 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
6336 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
6337 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
6338 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
6339 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
6340 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006341 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
6342 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006343
6344 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
6345 and "fd@2", see above.
6346
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02006347 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
6348 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
6349 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
6350 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
6351 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
6352 having the logs instantly available.
6353
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006354 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
6355 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006356
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006357 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
6358 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
6359 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
6360 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
6361 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
6362 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
6363 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
6364 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
6365 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
6366 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006367 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006368
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006369 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
6370 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
6371 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
6372 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
6373 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
6374
6375 <sample_size>
6376 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
6377 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
6378 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
6379 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
6380 (see also <ranges> parameter).
6381
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01006382 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
6383 one of the following :
6384
6385 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
6386 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
6387
6388 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
6389 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
6390
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006391 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
6392 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
6393 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
6394 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
6395 systemd logger consumes.
6396
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006397 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
6398 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
6399 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
6400 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
6401
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006402 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
6403
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006404 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
6405 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
6406 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
6407
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006408 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
6409 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
6410 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
6411 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006412
6413 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
6414 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
6415 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006416 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
6417 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
6418 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
6419 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
6420 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006421
6422 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
6423
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006424 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
6425 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
6426 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006427
6428 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
6429 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
6430 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
6431 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
6432
6433 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
6434 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006435
6436 Example :
6437 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006438 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
6439 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
6440 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006441 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
6442 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006443 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006444
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006445
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006446log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006447 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
6448 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6449 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006450
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006451 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
6452 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
6453 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
6454 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
6455 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006456
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006457 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
6458 "option httplog" directives.
6459
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02006460log-format-sd <string>
6461 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
6462 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6463 yes | yes | yes | no
6464
6465 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
6466 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
6467 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
6468 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
6469 which covers the log format string in depth.
6470
6471 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
6472 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
6473
6474 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
6475 log format to "rfc5424".
6476
6477 Example :
6478 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
6479
6480
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01006481log-tag <string>
6482 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
6483 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6484 yes | yes | yes | yes
6485
6486 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
6487 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
6488 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
6489 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
6490 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
6491 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
6492 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
6493 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
6494 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006495
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006496max-keep-alive-queue <value>
6497 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
6498 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6499 yes | no | yes | yes
6500
6501 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
6502 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
6503 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
6504 servers.
6505
6506 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
6507 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
6508 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
6509 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
6510 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006511 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006512 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
6513 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
6514 picking a different server.
6515
6516 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
6517 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
6518 even if they have to be queued.
6519
6520 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
6521 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
6522
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01006523max-session-srv-conns <nb>
6524 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
6525 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
6526 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006527
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006528maxconn <conns>
6529 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
6530 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6531 yes | yes | yes | no
6532 Arguments :
6533 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
6534 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
6535 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
6536 closes.
6537
6538 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
6539 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
6540 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
6541 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01006542 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
6543 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
6544 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
6545 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006546
6547 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
6548 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
6549 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
6550
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01006551 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
6552 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02006553
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006554 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
6555
6556
6557mode { tcp|http|health }
6558 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
6559 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6560 yes | yes | yes | yes
6561 Arguments :
6562 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
6563 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
6564 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
6565 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
6566
6567 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
6568 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
6569 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
6570 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
6571 brings HAProxy most of its value.
6572
6573 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006574 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
6575 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
6576 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
6577 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
6578 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
6579 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
6580 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006581
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006582 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
6583 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
6584 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006585
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006586 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006587 defaults http_instances
6588 mode http
6589
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006590 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006591
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006592
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006593monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006594 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006595 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6596 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006597 Arguments :
6598 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
6599 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006600 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006601 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
6602 backend and its backup.
6603
6604 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
6605 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
6606 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
6607 servers in a list of backends.
6608
6609 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
6610 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
6611 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
6612 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
6613 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
6614 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
6615 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02006616 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
6617 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006618
6619 Example:
6620 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006621 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006622 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
6623 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
6624 monitor-uri /site_alive
6625 monitor fail if site_dead
6626
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02006627 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006628
6629
6630monitor-net <source>
6631 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
6632 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6633 yes | yes | yes | no
6634 Arguments :
6635 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
6636 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
6637 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
6638 followed by a mask.
6639
6640 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
6641 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006642 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006643 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
6644
6645 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
6646 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
6647 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
6648 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006649 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
6650 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
6651 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006652
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006653 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
6654 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
6655 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
6656 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
6657 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
6658 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006659
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01006660 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
6661 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006662
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006663 Example :
6664 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
6665 frontend www
6666 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
6667
6668 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
6669
6670
6671monitor-uri <uri>
6672 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
6673 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6674 yes | yes | yes | no
6675 Arguments :
6676 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
6677 health status instead of forwarding the request.
6678
6679 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
6680 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
6681 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
6682 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
6683 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
6684 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
6685 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
6686 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
6687
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01006688 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006689 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
6690 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
6691 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
6692 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
6693 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
6694 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006695
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01006696 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
6697 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
6698 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
6699 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
6700
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006701 Example :
6702 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
6703 frontend www
6704 mode http
6705 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
6706
6707 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
6708
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006709
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006710option abortonclose
6711no option abortonclose
6712 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
6713 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6714 yes | no | yes | yes
6715 Arguments : none
6716
6717 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
6718 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
6719 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
6720 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006721 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006722 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
6723 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
6724 encountered while delivering the response.
6725
6726 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
6727 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
6728 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
6729 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
6730 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
6731 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006732 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006733 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006734 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006735 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
6736 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
6737 still not served and not pollute the servers.
6738
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006739 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
6740 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006741 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
6742 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
6743 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
6744 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
6745 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
6746 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006747 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006748
6749 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6750 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6751
6752 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
6753
6754
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006755option accept-invalid-http-request
6756no option accept-invalid-http-request
6757 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
6758 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6759 yes | yes | yes | no
6760 Arguments : none
6761
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006762 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006763 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006764 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006765 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6766 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6767 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6768 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6769 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006770 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
6771 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
6772 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
6773 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006774 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006775 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02006776 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
6777 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
6778 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006779
6780 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6781 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6782 been confirmed.
6783
6784 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6785 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006786 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
6787 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006788 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6789
6790 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6791 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6792
6793 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
6794 stats socket.
6795
6796
6797option accept-invalid-http-response
6798no option accept-invalid-http-response
6799 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
6800 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6801 yes | no | yes | yes
6802 Arguments : none
6803
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006804 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006805 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006806 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006807 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6808 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6809 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6810 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6811 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006812 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
6813 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
6814 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006815
6816 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6817 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6818 been confirmed.
6819
6820 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6821 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
6822 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
6823 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6824
6825 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6826 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6827
6828 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
6829 stats socket.
6830
6831
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006832option allbackups
6833no option allbackups
6834 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
6835 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6836 yes | no | yes | yes
6837 Arguments : none
6838
6839 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
6840 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
6841 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
6842 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
6843 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
6844 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
6845 order between the backup servers anymore.
6846
6847 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
6848 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
6849
6850 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6851 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6852
6853
6854option checkcache
6855no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08006856 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006857 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6858 yes | no | yes | yes
6859 Arguments : none
6860
6861 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
6862 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006863 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006864 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
6865 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006866 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006867
6868 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006869 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006870 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006871 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
6872 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006873 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006874 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01006875 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
6876 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006877 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01006878 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
6879 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006880 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006881 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
6882 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
6883 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
6884 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
6885 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
6886 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
6887 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
6888 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
6889 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
6890
6891 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006892 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
6893 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
6894 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
6895 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006896
6897 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
6898 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006899 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006900 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006901
6902 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6903 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6904
6905
6906option clitcpka
6907no option clitcpka
6908 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
6909 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6910 yes | yes | yes | no
6911 Arguments : none
6912
6913 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6914 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006915 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006916 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6917
6918 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6919 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6920 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6921 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6922
6923 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6924 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6925 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6926 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6927 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6928
6929 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6930
6931 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6932 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6933 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
6934
6935 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6936 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6937
6938 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
6939
6940
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006941option contstats
6942 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
6943 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6944 yes | yes | yes | no
6945 Arguments : none
6946
6947 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
6948 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
6949 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
6950 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01006951 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
6952 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
6953 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
6954 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
6955 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006956
6957
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006958option dontlog-normal
6959no option dontlog-normal
6960 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
6961 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6962 yes | yes | yes | no
6963 Arguments : none
6964
6965 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
6966 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
6967 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
6968 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
6969 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
6970 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
6971 logged.
6972
6973 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
6974 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
6975 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
6976
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006977 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006978 logging.
6979
6980
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006981option dontlognull
6982no option dontlognull
6983 Enable or disable logging of null connections
6984 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6985 yes | yes | yes | no
6986 Arguments : none
6987
6988 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
6989 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
6990 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
6991 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
6992 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
6993 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006994 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
6995 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
6996 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006997
6998 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006999 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007000 would not be logged.
7001
7002 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7003 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7004
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007005 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
7006 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007007
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007008
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007009option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007010 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
7011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7012 yes | yes | yes | yes
7013 Arguments :
7014 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7015 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007016 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007017 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007018
7019 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
7020 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
7021 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
7022 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
7023 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
7024 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
7025 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007026 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
7027 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7028 possible that the client has already brought one.
7029
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007030 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007031 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007032 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007033 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007034 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007035 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007036
7037 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7038 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7039 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7040 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7041 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7042 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7043 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7044
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007045 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
7046 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
7047 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
7048 are under the control of the end-user.
7049
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007050 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007051 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7052 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007053 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
7054 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
7055 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007056
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007057 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007058 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
7059 frontend www
7060 mode http
7061 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
7062
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007063 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
7064 backend www
7065 mode http
7066 option forwardfor header X-Client
7067
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007068 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007069 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007070
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007071
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02007072option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7073no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7074 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
7075 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7076 yes | yes | yes | no
7077 Arguments : none
7078
7079 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7080 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7081 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7082 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7083 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7084 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7085 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7086
7087 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
7088 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
7089 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
7090 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7091 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
7092 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7093 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7094 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
7095 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7096 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7097
7098 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
7099
7100 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7101 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7102
7103 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
7104 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7105
7106
7107option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7108no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7109 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
7110 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7111 yes | no | yes | yes
7112 Arguments : none
7113
7114 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7115 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7116 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7117 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7118 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7119 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7120 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7121
7122 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
7123 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
7124 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
7125 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7126 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
7127 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7128 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7129 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
7130 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7131 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7132
7133 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
7134
7135 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7136 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7137
7138 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
7139 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7140
7141
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007142option http-buffer-request
7143no option http-buffer-request
7144 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
7145 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7146 yes | yes | yes | yes
7147 Arguments : none
7148
7149 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
7150 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
7151 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
7152 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
7153 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
7154 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01007155 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
7156 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
7157 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
7158 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007159
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01007160 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007161
7162
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007163option http-ignore-probes
7164no option http-ignore-probes
7165 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
7166 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7167 yes | yes | yes | no
7168 Arguments : none
7169
7170 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
7171 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
7172 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
7173 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
7174 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
7175 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
7176 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
7177 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
7178 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007179 was received over a connection before it was closed;
7180 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007181 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
7182
7183 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
7184 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
7185 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
7186 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
7187 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
7188 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
7189 are often the only way to detect them.
7190
7191 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7192 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7193
7194 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
7195
7196
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007197option http-keep-alive
7198no option http-keep-alive
7199 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
7200 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7201 yes | yes | yes | yes
7202 Arguments : none
7203
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007204 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7205 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007206 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7207 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007208 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
7209 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
7210 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007211
7212 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
7213 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007214 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
7215 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
7216 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
7217 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
7218 situations where this option may be useful :
7219
7220 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007221 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007222
7223 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
7224 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
7225
7226 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
7227 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
7228 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
7229 request.
7230
7231 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
7232 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007233 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
7234 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
7235 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007236
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007237 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7238 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7239 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7240 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
7241 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7242 not set.
7243
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007244 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7245 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
7246 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007247
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007248 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007249 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01007250 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007251
7252
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007253option http-no-delay
7254no option http-no-delay
7255 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
7256 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7257 yes | yes | yes | yes
7258 Arguments : none
7259
7260 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
7261 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
7262 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
7263 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
7264 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
7265 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
7266 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
7267 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
7268 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
7269 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
7270 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
7271 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
7272 affected.
7273
7274 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
7275 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
7276 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
7277 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
7278 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
7279 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
7280 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
7281 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
7282 latency environments.
7283
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007284 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7285
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007286
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007287option http-pretend-keepalive
7288no option http-pretend-keepalive
7289 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
7290 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007291 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007292 Arguments : none
7293
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007294 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007295 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
7296 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
7297 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
7298 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
7299 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
7300 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
7301 consider the response complete.
7302
7303 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
7304 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
7305 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
7306 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007307 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007308 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
7309
7310 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
7311 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
7312 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
7313 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
7314 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
7315 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
7316 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
7317
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007318 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
7319 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
7320 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
7321 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
7322 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
7323 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007324
7325 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7326 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7327
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007328 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007329 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007330
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007331
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007332option http-server-close
7333no option http-server-close
7334 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
7335 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7336 yes | yes | yes | yes
7337 Arguments : none
7338
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007339 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7340 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7341 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7342 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007343 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
7344 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
7345 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
7346 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
7347 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
7348 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
7349 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
7350 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
7351 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
7352 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
7353 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007354
7355 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7356 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7357 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7358 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007359 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7360 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007361
7362 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7363 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007364 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7365 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7366 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007367
7368 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7369 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7370
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007371 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
7372 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007373
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007374option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007375no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007376 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
7377 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7378 yes | yes | yes | no
7379 Arguments : none
7380
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00007381 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007382 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
7383 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
7384 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
7385 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
7386 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
7387 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
7388
7389 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
7390 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007391 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
7392 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
7393 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007394
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01007395 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
7396 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
7397 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
7398 front of an existing proxy.
7399
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007400 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
7401
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007402 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007403
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007404option httpchk
7405option httpchk <uri>
7406option httpchk <method> <uri>
7407option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02007408 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007409 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7410 yes | no | yes | yes
7411 Arguments :
7412 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
7413 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
7414 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
7415 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
7416 ones.
7417
7418 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
7419 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
7420 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
7421
7422 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
7423 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
7424 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007425 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007426
7427 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
7428 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
7429 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
7430 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
7431 the lack of any response.
7432
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02007433 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
7434 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
7435 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
7436 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
7437
7438 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
7439 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
7440 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007441
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02007442 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
7443 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02007444 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
7445 internally relies on an HTX mutliplexer. Thus, it means the request
7446 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007447
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007448 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
7449 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
7450 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
7451 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
7452
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007453 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02007454 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
7455 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
7456 backend https_relay
7457 mode tcp
7458 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
7459 http-check send hdr Host www
7460 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007461
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09007462 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
7463 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
7464 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007465
7466
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007467option httpclose
7468no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007469 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007470 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7471 yes | yes | yes | yes
7472 Arguments : none
7473
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007474 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7475 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7476 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7477 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007478 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007479
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007480 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
7481 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05007482 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007483 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
7484 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007485
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007486 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
7487 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
7488 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007489
7490 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7491 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007492 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
7493 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7494 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007495
7496 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7497 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7498
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007499 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007500
7501
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007502option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007503 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
7504 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007505 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007506 Arguments :
7507 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
7508 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
7509 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007510 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007511 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007512
7513 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7514 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7515 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
7516 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
7517 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
7518 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
7519 ports.
7520
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01007521 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
7522 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007523
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007524 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7525
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007526 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007527
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007528
7529option http_proxy
7530no option http_proxy
7531 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
7532 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7533 yes | yes | yes | yes
7534 Arguments : none
7535
7536 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
7537 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
7538 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
7539 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
7540 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
7541
7542 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
7543 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007544 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
7545 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007546
7547 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7548 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7549
7550 Example :
7551 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
7552 backend direct_forward
7553 option httpclose
7554 option http_proxy
7555
7556 See also : "option httpclose"
7557
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007558
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007559option independent-streams
7560no option independent-streams
7561 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007562 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7563 yes | yes | yes | yes
7564 Arguments : none
7565
7566 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
7567 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
7568 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
7569 receive data or not.
7570
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007571 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007572 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
7573 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
7574 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
7575 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
7576 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
7577 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
7578 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
7579 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
7580 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
7581 socket buffers.
7582
7583 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
7584 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
7585 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
7586 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
7587 slow lines, so use it with caution.
7588
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007589 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007590
7591
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02007592option ldap-check
7593 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
7594 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7595 yes | no | yes | yes
7596 Arguments : none
7597
7598 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
7599 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
7600 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
7601 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
7602
7603 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
7604 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
7605
7606 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
7607 configure it.
7608
7609 Example :
7610 option ldap-check
7611
7612 See also : "option httpchk"
7613
7614
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007615option external-check
7616 Use external processes for server health checks
7617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7618 yes | no | yes | yes
7619
7620 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
7621 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
7622 command".
7623
7624 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
7625
7626 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
7627
7628
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007629option log-health-checks
7630no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007631 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007632 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7633 yes | no | yes | yes
7634 Arguments : none
7635
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007636 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
7637 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
7638 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007639
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007640 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
7641 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
7642 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
7643 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
7644 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
7645
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007646 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007647 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007648
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007649 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
7650 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
7651 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007652
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007653
7654option log-separate-errors
7655no option log-separate-errors
7656 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
7657 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7658 yes | yes | yes | no
7659 Arguments : none
7660
7661 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
7662 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
7663 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
7664 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
7665 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
7666 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
7667 provides very important information.
7668
7669 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
7670 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
7671 error logs.
7672
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007673 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007674 logging.
7675
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007676
7677option logasap
7678no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007679 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007680 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7681 yes | yes | yes | no
7682 Arguments : none
7683
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007684 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
7685 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
7686 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
7687 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
7688
7689 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
7690 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
7691 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
7692 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
7693 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
7694 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transfered
7695 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
7696 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
7697 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
7698 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
7699 transfered.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007700
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007701 Examples :
7702 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
7703 mode http
7704 option httplog
7705 option logasap
7706 log 192.168.2.200 local3
7707
7708 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
7709 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
7710 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
7711 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
7712
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007713 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007714 logging.
7715
7716
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007717option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007718 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007719 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7720 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007721 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007722 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
7723 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007724 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007725
7726 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
7727 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007728 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007729 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
7730 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
7731 in the MySQL table, like this :
7732
7733 USE mysql;
7734 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
7735 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
7736
7737 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007738 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007739 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
7740 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
7741 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
7742 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
7743 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
7744 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
7745 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
7746
7747 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
7748 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007749
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02007750 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007751
7752 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
7753 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
7754 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7755 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007756 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
7757 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007758
7759 See also: "option httpchk"
7760
7761
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007762option nolinger
7763no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007764 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007765 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7766 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007767 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007768
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007769 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007770 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
7771 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
7772 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
7773 connections.
7774
7775 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
7776 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
7777 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
7778 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
7779 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
7780 this too.
7781
7782 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
7783 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
7784 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
7785
7786 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
7787 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
7788 for servers.
7789
7790 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7791 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7792
7793
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007794option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
7795 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
7796 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7797 yes | yes | yes | yes
7798 Arguments :
7799 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7800 matching <network>
7801 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
7802 header name.
7803
7804 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
7805 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
7806 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
7807 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
7808 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
7809 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
7810 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
7811 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
7812 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7813 possible that the client has already brought one.
7814
7815 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
7816 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
7817 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
7818 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
7819 header and requires different one.
7820
7821 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7822 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7823 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7824 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7825 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7826 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7827 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7828
7829 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
7830 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7831 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
7832 both are defined.
7833
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007834 Examples :
7835 # Original Destination address
7836 frontend www
7837 mode http
7838 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
7839
7840 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
7841 backend www
7842 mode http
7843 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
7844
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007845 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007846
7847
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007848option persist
7849no option persist
7850 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
7851 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7852 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007853 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007854
7855 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
7856 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
7857 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
7858 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
7859 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
7860 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
7861 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
7862 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
7863 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
7864 redirected to another valid server.
7865
7866 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7867 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7868
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007869 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007870
7871
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01007872option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
7873 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
7874 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7875 yes | no | yes | yes
7876 Arguments :
7877 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
7878 PostgreSQL server.
7879
7880 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
7881 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
7882 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
7883 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
7884
7885 See also: "option httpchk"
7886
7887
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007888option prefer-last-server
7889no option prefer-last-server
7890 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
7891 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7892 yes | no | yes | yes
7893 Arguments : none
7894
7895 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
7896 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
7897 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
7898 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
7899 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
7900 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
7901 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
7902 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
7903 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007904 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
7905 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02007906 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
7907 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
7908 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007909 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
7910 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
7911 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007912
7913 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7914 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7915
7916 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
7917
7918
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007919option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007920option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007921no option redispatch
7922 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7923 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7924 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007925 Arguments :
7926 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
7927 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
7928 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007929 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007930 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007931 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007932 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
7933 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
7934 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
7935
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007936
7937 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7938 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7939 be able to access the service anymore.
7940
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01007941 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
7942 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007943
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02007944 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
7945 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
7946 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
7947 following order:
7948
7949 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
7950
7951 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
7952 list, or
7953
7954 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
7955
7956 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
7957 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
7958
7959 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
7960 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
7961 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
7962 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
7963
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007964 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007965 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7966 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007967
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007968 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7969 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7970
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007971 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007972
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007973
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007974option redis-check
7975 Use redis health checks for server testing
7976 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7977 yes | no | yes | yes
7978 Arguments : none
7979
7980 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
7981 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7982 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
7983 find the "+PONG" response message.
7984
7985 Example :
7986 option redis-check
7987
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007988 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007989
7990
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007991option smtpchk
7992option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
7993 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
7994 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7995 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007996 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007997 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02007998 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007999 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
8000
8001 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
8002 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
8003 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
8004
8005 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
8006 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
8007 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
8008 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
8009 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
8010 dead server.
8011
8012 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
8013 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008014 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008015 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
8016
8017 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
8018 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
8019 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8020 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008021 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008022
8023 Example :
8024 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
8025
8026 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
8027
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008028
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02008029option socket-stats
8030no option socket-stats
8031
8032 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
8033 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8034 yes | yes | yes | no
8035
8036 Arguments : none
8037
8038
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008039option splice-auto
8040no option splice-auto
8041 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
8042 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8043 yes | yes | yes | yes
8044 Arguments : none
8045
8046 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
8047 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008048 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008049 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008050 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008051 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
8052 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
8053 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
8054 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8055
8056 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
8057 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
8058 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
8059 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
8060 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
8061 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
8062 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
8063 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
8064 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
8065 keyword.
8066
8067 Example :
8068 option splice-auto
8069
8070 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8071 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8072
8073 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
8074 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8075
8076
8077option splice-request
8078no option splice-request
8079 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
8080 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8081 yes | yes | yes | yes
8082 Arguments : none
8083
8084 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008085 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008086 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8087 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8088 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8089 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8090
8091 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8092
8093 Example :
8094 option splice-request
8095
8096 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8097 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8098
8099 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
8100 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8101
8102
8103option splice-response
8104no option splice-response
8105 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
8106 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8107 yes | yes | yes | yes
8108 Arguments : none
8109
8110 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008111 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008112 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8113 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8114 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8115 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8116
8117 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8118
8119 Example :
8120 option splice-response
8121
8122 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8123 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8124
8125 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
8126 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8127
8128
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01008129option spop-check
8130 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
8131 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8132 no | no | no | yes
8133 Arguments : none
8134
8135 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
8136 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8137 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
8138 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
8139
8140 Example :
8141 option spop-check
8142
8143 See also : "option httpchk"
8144
8145
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008146option srvtcpka
8147no option srvtcpka
8148 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
8149 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8150 yes | no | yes | yes
8151 Arguments : none
8152
8153 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8154 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008155 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008156 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8157
8158 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8159 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8160 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8161 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8162
8163 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8164 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8165 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8166 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8167 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8168
8169 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8170
8171 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8172 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8173 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
8174
8175 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8176 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8177
8178 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
8179
8180
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008181option ssl-hello-chk
8182 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
8183 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8184 yes | no | yes | yes
8185 Arguments : none
8186
8187 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
8188 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
8189 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
8190 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
8191 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
8192 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
8193 hello message.
8194
8195 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
8196 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
8197 messages, which is appreciable.
8198
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008199 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
8200 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
8201 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008202
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008203 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
8204
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008205
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008206option tcp-check
8207 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
8208 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8209 yes | no | yes | yes
8210
8211 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
8212 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
8213
8214 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
8215 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
8216 attempt, which remains the default mode.
8217
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008218 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008219 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
8220 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
8221 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
8222 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
8223 only.
8224
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008225 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008226 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
8227 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
8228 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
8229 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
8230
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008231 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008232 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
8233 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008234 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008235 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
8236 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
8237 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
8238 the respective protocols.
8239 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008240 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008241
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008242 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008243
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008244 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
8245 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
8246 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
8247 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008248
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008249 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
8250 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
8251 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01008252
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008253
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008254 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008255 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008256 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008257 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008258
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008259 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008260 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008261 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008262
8263 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
8264 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008265 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008266 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008267 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008268 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008269 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008270 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008271 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8272 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008273 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008274 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8275 tcp-check expect string +OK
8276
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008277 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008278 (send many headers before analyzing)
8279 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008280 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008281 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
8282 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
8283 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
8284 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008285 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008286
8287
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008288 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008289
8290
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008291option tcp-smart-accept
8292no option tcp-smart-accept
8293 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
8294 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8295 yes | yes | yes | no
8296 Arguments : none
8297
8298 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
8299 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
8300 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
8301 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
8302 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
8303 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
8304
8305 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
8306 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
8307 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
8308 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
8309
8310 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
8311 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
8312 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008313 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008314
8315 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
8316 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
8317 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
8318
8319 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
8320 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
8321 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
8322
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02008323 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
8324
8325
8326option tcp-smart-connect
8327no option tcp-smart-connect
8328 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
8329 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8330 yes | no | yes | yes
8331 Arguments : none
8332
8333 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
8334 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
8335 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
8336 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
8337 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
8338
8339 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
8340 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
8341 complex.
8342
8343 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
8344 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
8345 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
8346
8347 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8348 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8349
8350 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
8351
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008352
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008353option tcpka
8354 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
8355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8356 yes | yes | yes | yes
8357 Arguments : none
8358
8359 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8360 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008361 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008362 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8363
8364 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8365 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8366 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8367 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8368
8369 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8370 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8371 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8372 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8373 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8374
8375 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8376
8377 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
8378 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
8379 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
8380 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
8381 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
8382 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
8383 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
8384 backends.
8385
8386 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
8387
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008388
8389option tcplog
8390 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
8391 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008392 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008393 Arguments : none
8394
8395 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8396 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8397 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
8398 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
8399 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
8400 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
8401 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
8402 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
8403
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008404 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8405
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008406 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008407
8408
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008409option transparent
8410no option transparent
8411 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8412 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008413 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008414 Arguments : none
8415
8416 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
8417 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8418 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8419 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8420 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8421 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8422 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8423 appropriate server.
8424
8425 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8426 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8427
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01008428 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008429 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008430
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008431
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008432external-check command <command>
8433 Executable to run when performing an external-check
8434 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8435 yes | no | yes | yes
8436
8437 Arguments :
8438 <command> is the external command to run
8439
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008440 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
8441
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008442 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008443
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008444 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
8445 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
8446 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
8447 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
8448 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
8449 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008450
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01008451 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
8452
8453 Environment variables :
8454 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
8455 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
8456
8457 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
8458
8459 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
8460
8461 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
8462 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
8463 for a UNIX socket).
8464
8465 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
8466
8467 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
8468
8469 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
8470
8471 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
8472
8473 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
8474
8475 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
8476 socket).
8477
8478 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
8479 the command may be set using "external-check path".
8480
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02008481 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
8482
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008483 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
8484 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
8485 failed.
8486
8487 Example :
8488 external-check command /bin/true
8489
8490 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
8491
8492
8493external-check path <path>
8494 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
8495 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8496 yes | no | yes | yes
8497
8498 Arguments :
8499 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
8500
8501 The default path is "".
8502
8503 Example :
8504 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
8505
8506 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
8507 "external-check command"
8508
8509
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008510persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008511persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008512 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
8513 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8514 yes | no | yes | yes
8515 Arguments :
8516 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02008517 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
8518 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008519
8520 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
8521 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008522 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008523 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
8524 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
8525 forwarded to this server.
8526
8527 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
8528 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
8529 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008530 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008531 a single "listen" section.
8532
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02008533 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
8534 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
8535 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
8536
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008537 Example :
8538 listen tse-farm
8539 bind :3389
8540 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
8541 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8542 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
8543 # apply RDP cookie persistence
8544 persist rdp-cookie
8545 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008546 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008547 balance rdp-cookie
8548 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
8549 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
8550
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008551 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
8552 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008553
8554
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008555rate-limit sessions <rate>
8556 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
8557 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8558 yes | yes | yes | no
8559 Arguments :
8560 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
8561 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
8562
8563 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
8564 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
8565 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
8566 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
8567 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
8568 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
8569
8570 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
8571 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
8572 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
8573 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
8574
8575 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
8576 listen smtp
8577 mode tcp
8578 bind :25
8579 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02008580 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008581
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02008582 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
8583 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
8584 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008585
8586 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
8587
8588
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008589redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8590redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8591redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008592 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
8593 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8594 no | yes | yes | yes
8595
8596 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01008597 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008598
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008599 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008600 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008601 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
8602 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
8603 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008604
8605 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
8606 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
8607 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
8608 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
8609 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008610 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
8611 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
8612 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
8613 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008614
8615 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
8616 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
8617 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
8618 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
8619 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
8620 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008621 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008622 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008623 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
8624 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
8625 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008626
8627 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01008628 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
8629 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
8630 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02008631 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01008632 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
8633 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
8634 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
8635 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008636
8637 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008638 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008639
8640 - "drop-query"
8641 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
8642 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
8643 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
8644 with a location-type redirect.
8645
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008646 - "append-slash"
8647 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
8648 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
8649 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
8650 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
8651
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008652 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
8653 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
8654 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
8655 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
8656 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
8657 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
8658 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
8659
8660 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
8661 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
8662 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
8663 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
8664 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
8665 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
8666 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008667
8668 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
8669 acl clear dst_port 80
8670 acl secure dst_port 8080
8671 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008672 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008673 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008674 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
8675
8676 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008677 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
8678 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
8679 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008680 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008681
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008682 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
8683 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
8684 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
8685
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008686 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01008687 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008688
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008689 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02008690 http-request redirect code 301 location \
8691 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
8692 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008693
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008694 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008695
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008696
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008697retries <value>
8698 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
8699 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8700 yes | no | yes | yes
8701 Arguments :
8702 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
8703 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
8704 default value is 3.
8705
8706 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
8707 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
8708 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
8709
8710 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008711 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
8712 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008713
8714 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
8715 server even if a cookie references a different server.
8716
8717 See also : "option redispatch"
8718
8719
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008720retry-on [list of keywords]
8721 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
8722 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8723 yes | no | yes | yes
8724 Arguments :
8725 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
8726 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
8727 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
8728 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
8729
8730 none never retry
8731
8732 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
8733 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
8734
8735 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
8736 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
8737 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
8738 request timeout on the server side, poor network
8739 condition, or a server crash or restart while
8740 processing the request.
8741
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02008742 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
8743 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
8744 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
8745 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
8746 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
8747 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
8748 overflow attack for example).
8749
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008750 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
8751 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
8752 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
8753 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
8754 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
8755 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
8756 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
8757 amplify denial of service attacks.
8758
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02008759 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
8760 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
8761 considered to be safe to retry.
8762
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008763 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
8764 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
8765 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
8766 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
8767
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02008768 all-retryable-errors
8769 retry request for any error that are considered
8770 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
8771 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
8772 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
8773
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008774 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
8775 not cumulative.
8776
8777 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
8778 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
8779 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
8780 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
8781
8782 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
8783 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
8784 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
8785 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
8786 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
8787 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
8788 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
8789 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
8790 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
8791 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
8792 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
8793 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
8794
8795 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
8796 should not use this directive.
8797
8798 The default is "conn-failure".
8799
8800 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
8801
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008802server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008803 Declare a server in a backend
8804 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8805 no | no | yes | yes
8806 Arguments :
8807 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008808 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008809 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008810
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008811 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8812 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8813 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8814 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008815 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8816 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8817 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8818 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8819 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008820 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8821 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8822 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8823 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8824 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8825 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8826 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008827 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008828 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8829 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8830 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8831 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8832 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8833 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008834 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8835 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008836 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8837 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008838
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008839 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008840 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8841 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8842 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8843 adding this value to the client's port.
8844
8845 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8846 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008847 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008848
8849 Examples :
8850 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8851 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008852 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008853 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8854 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8855 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008856
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008857 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8858 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8859 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8860 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8861 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8862
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008863 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8864 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008865
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008866server-state-file-name [<file>]
8867 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8868 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8869 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8870 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8871 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8872 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8873
8874 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8875 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8876
8877 global
8878 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8879
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01008880 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008881 load-server-state-from-file
8882
8883 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8884 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008885
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008886server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8887 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8888 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8889 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8890 no | no | yes | yes
8891
8892 Arguments:
8893 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8894
8895 <num | range>
8896 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8897 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8898 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8899 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8900
8901 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8902
8903 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8904
8905 <params*>
8906 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8907 keyword.
8908
8909 Examples:
8910 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8911 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8912 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8913
8914 # or
8915 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8916
8917 # would be equivalent to:
8918 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8919 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8920 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8921
8922
8923
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008924source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008925source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008926source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008927 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8928 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8929 yes | no | yes | yes
8930 Arguments :
8931 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8932 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008933
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008934 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008935 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8936 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8937 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8938 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8939 supported prefixes are :
8940 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8941 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8942 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008943 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008944 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8945 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008946
8947 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8948 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008949 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8950 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8951 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008952
8953 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8954 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8955 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8956 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8957 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8958 <addr>.
8959
8960 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8961 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8962 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8963 port.
8964
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008965 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8966 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8967 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8968 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008969 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008970 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8971 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8972 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8973 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8974 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8975 HTTP header.
8976
8977 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8978 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008979 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008980 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8981 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8982 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8983 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8984 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8985 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8986 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8987
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008988 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8989 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8990 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8991 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8992 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8993 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8994
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008995 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8996 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8997 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8998 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8999
9000 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
9001 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
9002 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
9003 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
9004 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
9005 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
9006
9007 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
9008 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
9009 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
9010 there are two methods :
9011
9012 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
9013 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
9014 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
9015 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
9016 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
9017 of the client ranges may be used.
9018
9019 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
9020 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
9021 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
9022 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
9023 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
9024 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
9025 same session.
9026
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009027 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
9028 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
9029 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009030 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009031
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02009032 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
9033
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009034 Examples :
9035 backend private
9036 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
9037 source 192.168.1.200
9038
9039 backend transparent_ssl1
9040 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
9041 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9042
9043 backend transparent_ssl2
9044 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
9045 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
9046 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
9047
9048 backend transparent_ssl3
9049 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
9050 # is more conntrack-friendly.
9051 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9052
9053 backend transparent_smtp
9054 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
9055 # with Tproxy version 4.
9056 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
9057
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009058 backend transparent_http
9059 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
9060 # proxy.
9061 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
9062
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009063 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009064 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
9065
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009066
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009067stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
9068 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
9069 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009070 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009071
9072 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
9073 matched.
9074
9075 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
9076 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
9077
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009078 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9079 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009080 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009081
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01009082 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
9083 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
9084 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
9085 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009086
9087 Example :
9088 # statistics admin level only for localhost
9089 backend stats_localhost
9090 stats enable
9091 stats admin if LOCALHOST
9092
9093 Example :
9094 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
9095 backend stats_auth
9096 stats enable
9097 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
9098 stats admin if TRUE
9099
9100 Example :
9101 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
9102 userlist stats-auth
9103 group admin users admin
9104 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
9105 group readonly users haproxy
9106 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
9107
9108 backend stats_auth
9109 stats enable
9110 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
9111 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
9112 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
9113 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
9114
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009115 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
9116 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
9117 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009118
9119
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009120stats auth <user>:<passwd>
9121 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
9122 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009123 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009124 Arguments :
9125 <user> is a user name to grant access to
9126
9127 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
9128
9129 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
9130 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
9131 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
9132 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
9133 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
9134 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
9135
9136 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
9137 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
9138 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02009139 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009140
9141 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
9142 report using "stats scope".
9143
9144 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9145 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9146 unobvious parameters.
9147
9148 Example :
9149 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9150 backend public_www
9151 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9152 stats enable
9153 stats hide-version
9154 stats scope .
9155 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009156 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009157 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9158 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9159
9160 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9161 backend private_monitoring
9162 stats enable
9163 stats uri /admin?stats
9164 stats refresh 5s
9165
9166 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
9167
9168
9169stats enable
9170 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
9171 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009172 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009173 Arguments : none
9174
9175 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
9176 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
9177 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
9178 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
9179 - stats auth : no authentication
9180 - stats scope : no restriction
9181
9182 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9183 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9184 unobvious parameters.
9185
9186 Example :
9187 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9188 backend public_www
9189 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9190 stats enable
9191 stats hide-version
9192 stats scope .
9193 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009194 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009195 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9196 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9197
9198 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9199 backend private_monitoring
9200 stats enable
9201 stats uri /admin?stats
9202 stats refresh 5s
9203
9204 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9205
9206
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009207stats hide-version
9208 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009210 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009211 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009212
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009213 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
9214 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
9215 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
9216 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
9217 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
9218 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009219
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009220 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9221 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9222 unobvious parameters.
9223
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009224 Example :
9225 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9226 backend public_www
9227 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009228 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009229 stats hide-version
9230 stats scope .
9231 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009232 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009233 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9234 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009235
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009236 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9237 backend private_monitoring
9238 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009239 stats uri /admin?stats
9240 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01009241
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009242 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009243
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01009244
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02009245stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
9246 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
9247 Access control for statistics
9248
9249 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9250 no | no | yes | yes
9251
9252 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
9253 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
9254 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
9255 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
9256 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
9257 should be asked to enter a username and password.
9258
9259 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
9260 instance.
9261
9262 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
9263 about ACL usage.
9264
9265
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009266stats realm <realm>
9267 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
9268 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009269 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009270 Arguments :
9271 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
9272 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
9273 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
9274
9275 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
9276 using a backslash ('\').
9277
9278 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
9279 only related to authentication.
9280
9281 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9282 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9283 unobvious parameters.
9284
9285 Example :
9286 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9287 backend public_www
9288 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9289 stats enable
9290 stats hide-version
9291 stats scope .
9292 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009293 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009294 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9295 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9296
9297 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9298 backend private_monitoring
9299 stats enable
9300 stats uri /admin?stats
9301 stats refresh 5s
9302
9303 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
9304
9305
9306stats refresh <delay>
9307 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
9308 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009309 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009310 Arguments :
9311 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
9312 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
9313 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
9314 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
9315 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
9316 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
9317
9318 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
9319 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
9320 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
9321 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
9322
9323 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9324 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9325 unobvious parameters.
9326
9327 Example :
9328 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9329 backend public_www
9330 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9331 stats enable
9332 stats hide-version
9333 stats scope .
9334 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009335 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009336 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9337 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9338
9339 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9340 backend private_monitoring
9341 stats enable
9342 stats uri /admin?stats
9343 stats refresh 5s
9344
9345 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9346
9347
9348stats scope { <name> | "." }
9349 Enable statistics and limit access scope
9350 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009351 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009352 Arguments :
9353 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
9354 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
9355 section in which the statement appears.
9356
9357 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
9358 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
9359 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
9360 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
9361 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
9362 exists.
9363
9364 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9365 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9366 unobvious parameters.
9367
9368 Example :
9369 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9370 backend public_www
9371 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9372 stats enable
9373 stats hide-version
9374 stats scope .
9375 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009376 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009377 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9378 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9379
9380 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9381 backend private_monitoring
9382 stats enable
9383 stats uri /admin?stats
9384 stats refresh 5s
9385
9386 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9387
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009388
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009389stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009390 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
9391 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009392 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009393
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009394 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009395 description from global section is automatically used instead.
9396
9397 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9398 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
9399
9400 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9401 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009402 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009403
9404 Example :
9405 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9406 backend private_monitoring
9407 stats enable
9408 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
9409 stats uri /admin?stats
9410 stats refresh 5s
9411
9412 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
9413 global section.
9414
9415
9416stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009417 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
9418 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9419 yes | yes | yes | yes
9420 Arguments : none
9421
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009422 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009423 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
9424 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
9425 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
9426 - IP (socket, server)
9427 - cookie (backend, server)
9428
9429 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9430 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009431 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009432
9433 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
9434
9435
9436stats show-node [ <name> ]
9437 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
9438 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009439 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009440 Arguments:
9441 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
9442 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
9443
9444 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9445 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009446 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009447
9448 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9449 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9450 unobvious parameters.
9451
9452 Example:
9453 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9454 backend private_monitoring
9455 stats enable
9456 stats show-node Europe-1
9457 stats uri /admin?stats
9458 stats refresh 5s
9459
9460 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
9461 section.
9462
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009463
9464stats uri <prefix>
9465 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
9466 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009467 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009468 Arguments :
9469 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
9470 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
9471 query string.
9472
9473 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
9474 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
9475 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
9476 possible to reach it in the application.
9477
9478 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009479 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009480 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
9481 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
9482 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
9483 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
9484
9485 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
9486 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
9487 an address or a port to statistics only.
9488
9489 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9490 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9491 unobvious parameters.
9492
9493 Example :
9494 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9495 backend public_www
9496 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9497 stats enable
9498 stats hide-version
9499 stats scope .
9500 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009501 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009502 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9503 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9504
9505 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9506 backend private_monitoring
9507 stats enable
9508 stats uri /admin?stats
9509 stats refresh 5s
9510
9511 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
9512
9513
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009514stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
9515 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009516 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009517 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009518
9519 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009520 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009521 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009522 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009523 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
9524
9525 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9526 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9527 the "stick-table" statement.
9528
9529 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
9530 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
9531 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
9532 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
9533 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
9534
9535 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9536 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
9537 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
9538 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
9539 transformation rules.
9540
9541 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9542 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9543 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9544 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9545 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9546 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9547 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9548
9549 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
9550 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
9551 ACL based conditions.
9552
9553 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
9554 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
9555 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
9556 matches can be used as fallbacks.
9557
9558 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
9559 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
9560 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
9561 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
9562
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009563 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9564 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009565 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009566
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009567 Example :
9568 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9569 # last 30 minutes
9570 backend pop
9571 mode tcp
9572 balance roundrobin
9573 stick store-request src
9574 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9575 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9576 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9577
9578 backend smtp
9579 mode tcp
9580 balance roundrobin
9581 stick match src table pop
9582 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9583 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9584
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009585 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009586 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009587
9588
9589stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9590 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
9591 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9592 no | no | yes | yes
9593
9594 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
9595 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
9596 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
9597 for writing more maintainable configurations.
9598
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009599 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9600 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009601 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009602
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009603 Examples :
9604 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01009605 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009606
9607 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
9608 stick match src table pop if !localhost
9609 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
9610
9611
9612 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
9613 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
9614 backend http
9615 mode http
9616 balance roundrobin
9617 stick on src table https
9618 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
9619 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
9620 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
9621
9622 backend https
9623 mode tcp
9624 balance roundrobin
9625 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9626 stick on src
9627 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9628 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9629
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009630 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009631
9632
9633stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9634 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
9635 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9636 no | no | yes | yes
9637
9638 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009639 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009640 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009641 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009642 server is selected.
9643
9644 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9645 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9646 the "stick-table" statement.
9647
9648 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9649 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9650 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
9651 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
9652 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
9653 address.
9654
9655 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9656 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
9657 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
9658 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
9659 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
9660 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
9661 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
9662 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
9663 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
9664 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
9665
9666 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9667 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9668 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9669 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9670 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9671 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9672 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9673
9674 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
9675 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9676 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
9677 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9678
9679 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
9680 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9681 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9682 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9683 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9684 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009685 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
9686 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9687 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9688 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9689 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9690 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009691
9692 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
9693 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
9694 the request.
9695
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009696 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9697 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009698 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009699
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009700 Example :
9701 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9702 # last 30 minutes
9703 backend pop
9704 mode tcp
9705 balance roundrobin
9706 stick store-request src
9707 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9708 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9709 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9710
9711 backend smtp
9712 mode tcp
9713 balance roundrobin
9714 stick match src table pop
9715 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9716 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9717
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009718 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009719 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009720
9721
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009722stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009723 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
9724 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08009725 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009726 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009727 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009728
9729 Arguments :
9730 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
9731 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
9732 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9733 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9734
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009735 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
9736 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
9737 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9738 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9739
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009740 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
9741 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
9742 instance.
9743
9744 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
9745 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
9746 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
9747 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
9748 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
9749 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009750 to 32 characters.
9751
9752 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
9753 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
9754 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009755 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009756 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
9757 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009758
9759 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009760 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
9761 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009762 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
9763 increase.
9764
9765 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009766 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9767 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9768 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009769
9770 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9771 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9772 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9773 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009774 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009775 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9776 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9777 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9778 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9779 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9780 parameter (see below).
9781
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009782 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9783 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9784 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9785 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9786 soft restart.
9787
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009788 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9789 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009790
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009791 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9792 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9793 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9794 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009795 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009796 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009797 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9798 if not expiration delay is specified.
9799
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009800 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9801 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9802 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9803 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009804 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9805 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9806 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9807 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9808 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9809 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9810 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9811 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9812 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9813 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9814 types and their arguments.
9815
9816 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9817 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9818 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9819 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9820
9821 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9822 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9823 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009824 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009825
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009826 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9827 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9828 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009829 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009830 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009831 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009832
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009833 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9834 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9835 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9836 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9837
9838 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9839 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9840 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9841 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9842 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9843 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9844
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009845 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9846 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9847 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9848 they were received.
9849
9850 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9851 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9852 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9853 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9854 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9855
9856 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9857 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9858 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9859 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9860 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9861
9862 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9863 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9864 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9865
9866 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9867 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9868 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9869 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9870 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9871
9872 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9873 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9874 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9875 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9876 the client side.
9877
9878 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9879 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9880 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9881 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9882 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9883 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9884 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9885
9886 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9887 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9888 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9889 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9890 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9891 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009892 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009893
9894 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9895 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9896 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9897 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9898 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9899 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9900
9901 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009902 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009903 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9904 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9905
9906 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9907 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9908 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9909 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9910 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9911 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9912 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9913 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9914 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9915 recommended for better fairness.
9916
9917 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009918 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009919 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9920 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9921
9922 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9923 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9924 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9925 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9926 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9927 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9928 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9929 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9930 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9931 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009932
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009933 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9934 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009935 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9936 reference it.
9937
9938 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9939 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009940 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9941 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9942 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009943
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009944 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9945 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9946 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9947 something that can be ignored.
9948
9949 Example:
9950 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9951 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9952 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9953 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9954
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009955 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009956 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009957
9958
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009959stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009960 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009961 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9962 no | no | yes | yes
9963
9964 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009965 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009966 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009967 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009968 server is selected.
9969
9970 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9971 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9972 the "stick-table" statement.
9973
9974 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9975 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9976 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9977 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9978
9979 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9980 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9981 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9982 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9983 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9984 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009985 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009986 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9987 rules.
9988
9989 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9990 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9991 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9992 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9993 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9994 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9995 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9996
9997 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9998 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9999 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
10000 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10001
10002 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
10003 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10004 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10005 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10006 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10007 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010008 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
10009 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10010 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10011 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10012 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10013 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
10014 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
10015 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
10016 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010017
10018 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
10019
10020 Example :
10021 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
10022 backend https
10023 mode tcp
10024 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010025 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010026 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010027
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010028 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
10029 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
10030
10031 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
10032 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10033 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
10034
10035 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
10036 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010037
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010038 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
10039 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
10040 # at offset 44.
10041
10042 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
10043 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
10044
10045 # Learn on response if server hello.
10046 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010047
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010048 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10049 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10050
10051 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
10052 extraction.
10053
10054
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010055tcp-check comment <string>
10056 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
10057 it fails.
10058 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10059 yes | no | yes | yes
10060
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010061 Arguments :
10062 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
10063 rule fails.
10064
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010065 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
10066 user-friendly error reporting.
10067
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010068 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
10069 "tcp-check expect".
10070
10071
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010072tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
10073 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010074 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010075 Opens a new connection
10076 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010077 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010078
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010079 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010080 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10081
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010082 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Christopher Fauletbb591a12020-04-01 16:52:17 +020010083 checks. The server options are used only if not redifined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010084
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010085 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010086 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
10087 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010088 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010089
10090 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010091
10092 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
10093
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020010094 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
10095
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010096 ssl opens a ciphered connection
10097
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020010098 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
10099
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020010100 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
10101 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
10102 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10103 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
10104
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010105 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
10106 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
10107 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
10108 haproxy -vv.
10109
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010110 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010111
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010112 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
10113 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
10114 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
10115
10116 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
10117 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
10118 of the sequence.
10119
10120 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
10121 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
10122 do.
10123
10124 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
10125 unset-var or comment rules.
10126
10127 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010128 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
10129 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
10130 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
10131 option tcp-check
10132 tcp-check connect
10133 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10134 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10135 tcp-check send \r\n
10136 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10137 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
10138 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10139 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10140 tcp-check send \r\n
10141 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10142 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
10143
10144 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
10145 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010146 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010147 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
10148 tcp-check connect port 143
10149 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
10150 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
10151
10152 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
10153
10154
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010155tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010156 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020010157 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010158 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010159 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010160 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010161 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010162
10163 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010164 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10165
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010166 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
10167 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
10168 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
10169 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
10170 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
10171 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
10172 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
10173 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
10174 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
10175 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
10176
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010177 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010178 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
10179 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010180 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
10181 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
10182 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
10183
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010184 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
10185 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
10186 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
10187 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported and may be used to set,
10188 respectively, HCHK_STATUS_L7OK, HCHK_STATUS_L7OKCD,
10189 HCHK_STATUS_L6OK or HCHK_STATUS_L4OK success status.
10190 By default "L7OK" is used.
10191
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010192 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
10193 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
10194 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported and
10195 may be used to set, respectively, HCHK_STATUS_L7RSP,
10196 HCHK_STATUS_L7STS, HCHK_STATUS_L6RSP or HCHK_STATUS_L4CON
10197 error status. By default "L7RSP" is used.
10198
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010199 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010200 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
10201 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported and may
10202 be used to set, respectively, HCHK_STATUS_L7TOUT,
10203 HCHK_STATUS_L6TOUT or HCHK_STATUS_L4TOUT timeout status.
10204 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
10205
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020010206 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
10207 informational message reported in logs if the expect
10208 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
10209 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
10210
10211 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
10212 informational message reported in logs if an error
10213 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
10214 log-format string.
10215
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020010216 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
10217 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
10218 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10219 followed by some converters.
10220
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010221 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
10222 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
10223 with the usual backslash ('\').
10224 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010225 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010226 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
10227 used upper or lower case.
10228
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010229 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
10230
10231 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
10232 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10233 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
10234 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
10235 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
10236 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
10237 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
10238 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
10239
10240 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
10241 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10242 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
10243 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
10244 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
10245 expression.
10246
10247 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
10248 in the response buffer. A health check response will
10249 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
10250 this exact hexadecimal string.
10251 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
10252
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010253 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
10254 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
10255 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
10256 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
10257 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
10258 size of the original response. As such, the expected
10259 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
10260 size.
10261
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010262 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
10263 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
10264 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
10265 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
10266 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
10267 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
10268 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
10269 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
10270 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
10271 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
10272 the null character.
10273
10274 Examples :
10275 # perform a POP check
10276 option tcp-check
10277 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
10278
10279 # perform an IMAP check
10280 option tcp-check
10281 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
10282
10283 # look for the redis master server
10284 option tcp-check
10285 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020010286 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010287 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10288 tcp-check expect string role:master
10289 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
10290 tcp-check expect string +OK
10291
10292
10293 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
10294 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
10295
10296
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020010297tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>] [log-format]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010298 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
10299 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010300 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010301
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010302 Arguments :
10303 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10304
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020010305 log-format specifies <data> must be evaluated a log-format string.
10306
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010307 <data> the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
10308 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010309
10310 Examples :
10311 # look for the redis master server
10312 option tcp-check
10313 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10314 tcp-check expect string role:master
10315
10316 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10317 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
10318
10319
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020010320tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>] [log-format]
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010321 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010322 tcp health check
10323 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010324 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010325
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010326 Arguments :
10327 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010328
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020010329 log-format specifies <hexstring> must be evaluated a log-format string.
10330
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010331 <hexstring> test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
10332 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
10333 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact hexadecimal
10334 string. Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary
10335 protocols.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010336
10337 Examples :
10338 # redis check in binary
10339 option tcp-check
10340 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
10341 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
10342
10343
10344 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10345 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
10346
10347
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010348tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010349 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010350 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010351 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010352
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010353 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010354 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
10355 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
10356 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
10357 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
10358 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
10359 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
10360 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
10361 and '-'.
10362
10363 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
10364
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010365 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010366 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
10367
10368
10369tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010370 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010371 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010372 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010373
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010374 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010375 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
10376 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
10377 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
10378 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
10379 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
10380 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
10381 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
10382 and '-'.
10383
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010384 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010385 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
10386
10387
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010388tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10389 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010390 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10391 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010392 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010393 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10394 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010395
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010396 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010397
10398 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
10399 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010400 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
10401 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
10402 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
10403 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
10404 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
10405 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010406
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010407 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10408 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10409 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
10410 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010411
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010412 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010413 - accept :
10414 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10415 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10416 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010417
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010418 - reject :
10419 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10420 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10421 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
10422 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
10423 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
10424 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
10425 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
10426 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
10427 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
10428 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
10429 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010430 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010431
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010432 - expect-proxy layer4 :
10433 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
10434 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
10435 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
10436 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
10437 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
10438 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
10439 hosts.
10440
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010441 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
10442 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
10443 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
10444 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
10445 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
10446 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
10447 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
10448 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
10449
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010450 - capture <sample> len <length> :
10451 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
10452 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
10453 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
10454 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
10455 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
10456 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
10457 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
10458 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010459 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
10460 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010461
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010462 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010463 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010464 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
10465 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
10466 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010467 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010468 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
10469 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
10470 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
10471 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
10472 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
10473 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
10474 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
10475 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010476
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010477 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010478 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010479 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010480 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010481 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
10482 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
10483 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010484
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010485 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
10486 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
10487 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
10488 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010489
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010490 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
10491 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
10492 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
10493 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
10494 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010495 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
10496 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
10497 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
10498 layer7 information is extracted.
10499
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010500 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
10501 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
10502 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
10503 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
10504 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010505
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010506 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10507 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10508 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10509 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10510
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010511 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10512 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10513 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10514 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10515
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010516 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
10517 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
10518 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
10519 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
10520 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010521
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010522 - set-src <expr> :
10523 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
10524 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
10525 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010526 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010527
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010528 Arguments:
10529 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10530 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010531
10532 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010533 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
10534
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010535 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
10536 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010537
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010538 - set-src-port <expr> :
10539 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
10540 expression.
10541
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010542 Arguments:
10543 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10544 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010545
10546 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010547 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
10548
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010549 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
10550 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
10551 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010552
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010553 - set-dst <expr> :
10554 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
10555 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
10556 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
10557 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10558 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10559
10560 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10561 followed by some converters.
10562
10563 Example:
10564
10565 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
10566 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
10567
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010568 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
10569 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
10570
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010571 - set-dst-port <expr> :
10572 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
10573 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10574 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10575
10576
10577 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10578 followed by some converters.
10579
10580 Example:
10581
10582 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
10583
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010584 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
10585 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
10586 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
10587
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010588 - "silent-drop" :
10589 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010590 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010591 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10592 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10593 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10594 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10595 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010596 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10597 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010598 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10599 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010600 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010601 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10602 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10603 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10604 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10605
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010606 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10607 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10608 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010609
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010610 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10611 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
10612 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010613
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010614 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010615 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010616 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010617
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010618 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
10619 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10620 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010621
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010622 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010623 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10624 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010625
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010626 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
10627
10628 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10629
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010630 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10631
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010632 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010633
10634
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010635tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10636 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010637 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010638 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010639 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010640 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10641 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010642
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010643 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010644
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010645 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010646 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10647 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
10648 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
10649 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010650
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010651 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
10652 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
10653 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
10654 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010655 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
10656 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
10657 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
10658 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
10659 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
10660 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010661 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010662 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010663
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010664 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10665 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10666 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10667 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010668
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010669 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010670 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010671 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010672 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10673 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010674 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010675 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010676 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010677 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010678 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010679 - set-dst <expr>
10680 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010681 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010682 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010683 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010684 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010685 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010686
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010687 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
10688 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010689 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
10690 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010691
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010692 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
10693 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
10694 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
10695 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
10696 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
10697 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010698
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010699 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010700 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10701 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010702
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010703 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010704 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
10705 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
10706 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
10707 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010708 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
10709 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
10710 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010711
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010712 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010713 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
10714 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
10715 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010716
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010717 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
10718 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
10719
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010720 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010721 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
10722 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010723
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010724 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10725 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010726 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010727 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10728 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010729 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010730 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010731 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010732 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10733 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010734 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010735 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10736 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010737
10738 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10739 followed by some converters.
10740
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010741 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10742 <var-name>.
10743
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010744 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
10745 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
10746 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
10747 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
10748 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
10749
10750 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
10751 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
10752 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
10753 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
10754 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
10755 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
10756 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
10757 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
10758 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
10759 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
10760 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
10761
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010762 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10763 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10764 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10765 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10766 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10767
10768 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10769
10770 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10771
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010772 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
10773 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
10774 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
10775 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
10776 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
10777 evaluated.
10778
10779 Example:
10780 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
10781
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010782 Example:
10783
10784 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010785 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010786
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010787 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010788 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
10789 # and reject everything else.
10790 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
10791 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010792 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010793 tcp-request content reject
10794
10795 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010796 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
10797 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10798 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010799 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010800
10801 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
10802 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10803 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010804 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010805 tcp-request content reject
10806
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010807 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010808 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010809 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010810 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010811 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
10812 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010813
10814 Example:
10815 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10816 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010817 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010818
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010819 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010820 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010821
10822 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010823 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010824 # protecting all our sites
10825 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010826 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10827 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010828 ...
10829 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
10830
10831 backend http_dynamic
10832 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010833 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010834 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010835 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010836 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010837 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010838 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010839
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010840 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010841
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030010842 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
10843 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010844
10845
10846tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
10847 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
10848 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010849 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010850 Arguments :
10851 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10852 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10853 as explained at the top of this document.
10854
10855 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
10856 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
10857 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
10858 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
10859 data for at most the specified amount of time.
10860
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010861 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
10862 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
10863 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
10864 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
10865
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010866 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
10867 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010868 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010869 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010010870 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
10871 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
10872 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
10873 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010874
10875 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
10876 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
10877 it pass through unaffected.
10878
10879 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
10880 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
10881 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010882 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010883 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
10884 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020010885 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
10886 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
10887 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010888
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010889 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010890 "timeout client".
10891
10892
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010893tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10894 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
10895 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10896 no | no | yes | yes
10897 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010898 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10899 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010900
10901 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10902
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010903 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010904 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10905 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010906 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
10907 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010908
10909 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
10910
10911 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10912 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10913 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10914 inserted.
10915
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010916 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010917 - accept :
10918 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10919 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10920 the rules evaluation.
10921
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010922 - close :
10923 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
10924 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
10925 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
10926 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
10927 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
10928 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010929 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010930 protocols.
10931
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010932 - reject :
10933 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10934 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010935 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010936
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010937 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10938 Sets a variable.
10939
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010940 - unset-var(<var-name>)
10941 Unsets a variable.
10942
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010943 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10944 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10945 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10946 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10947
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010948 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10949 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10950 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10951 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10952
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010953 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
10954 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
10955 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
10956 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
10957 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010958
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010959 - "silent-drop" :
10960 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010961 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010962 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10963 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10964 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10965 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10966 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010967 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10968 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010969 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10970 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010971 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010972 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10973 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10974 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10975 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10976
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010977 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10978 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10979
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010980 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10981 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10982 for changing the default action to a reject.
10983
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010984 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10985 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10986 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10987 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010988 period.
10989
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010990 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10991 declared inline.
10992
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010993 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10994 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010995 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010996 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10997 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010998 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010999 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011000 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011001 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11002 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011003 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011004 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11005 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011006
11007 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11008 followed by some converters.
11009
11010 Example:
11011
11012 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
11013
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011014 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11015 <var-name>.
11016
11017 Example:
11018
11019 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
11020
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011021 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11022 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11023 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11024 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11025 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11026
11027 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11028
11029 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11030
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011031 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11032
11033 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
11034
11035
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011036tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11037 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
11038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11039 no | yes | yes | no
11040 Arguments :
11041 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11042 below.
11043
11044 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11045
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011046 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011047 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
11048 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
11049 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
11050 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
11051 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
11052 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
11053 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011054 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011055 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
11056 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
11057 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
11058 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
11059 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
11060 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
11061 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
11062 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
11063 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
11064 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
11065 instead.
11066
11067 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11068 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11069 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
11070 rules which may be inserted.
11071
11072 Several types of actions are supported :
11073 - accept : the request is accepted
11074 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11075 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
11076 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011077 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011078 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011079 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011080 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011081 - silent-drop
11082
11083 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
11084 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
11085 sections for a complete description.
11086
11087 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11088 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11089 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
11090
11091 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
11092 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
11093 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
11094 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
11095 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
11096
11097 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11098 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11099
11100 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11101 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
11102 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
11103
11104 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
11105 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
11106 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11107
11108 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
11109 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11110 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
11111
11112 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
11113 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11114 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
11115
11116 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11117
11118 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
11119
11120
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011121tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
11122 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
11123 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11124 no | no | yes | yes
11125 Arguments :
11126 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11127 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11128 as explained at the top of this document.
11129
11130 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
11131
11132
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011133timeout check <timeout>
11134 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
11135 established.
11136
11137 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11138 yes | no | yes | yes
11139 Arguments:
11140 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11141 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11142 as explained at the top of this document.
11143
11144 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
11145 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011146 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011147 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010011148 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
11149 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
11150 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011151
11152 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
11153 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
11154
11155 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
11156 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010011157 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011158
11159 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11160 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11161 forget about it.
11162
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010011163 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
11164 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011165
11166
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011167timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011168 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
11169 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11170 yes | yes | yes | no
11171 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011172 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011173 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11174 as explained at the top of this document.
11175
11176 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
11177 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11178 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010011179 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
11180 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
11181 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
11182 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011183 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
11184 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
11185 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011186 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011187 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011188 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
11189 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011190 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
11191 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011192
11193 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
11194 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11195 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11196 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011197 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011198 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11199
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011200 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010011201
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011202 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011203
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011204
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011205timeout client-fin <timeout>
11206 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
11207 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11208 yes | yes | yes | no
11209 Arguments :
11210 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11211 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11212 as explained at the top of this document.
11213
11214 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
11215 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11216 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11217 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11218 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
11219 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11220 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010011221 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
11222 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
11223 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011224
11225 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
11226 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11227 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
11228
11229 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
11230
11231
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011232timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011233 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
11234 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11235 yes | no | yes | yes
11236 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011237 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011238 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11239 as explained at the top of this document.
11240
11241 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011242 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011243 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011244 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011245 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
11246 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011247
11248 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11249 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11250 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11251 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011252 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011253 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11254
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011255 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011256
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011257
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011258timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
11259 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
11260 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11261 yes | yes | yes | yes
11262 Arguments :
11263 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11264 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11265 as explained at the top of this document.
11266
11267 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
11268 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
11269 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
11270 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
11271 once the request has started to present itself.
11272
11273 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
11274 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
11275 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
11276 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
11277 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
11278
11279 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
11280 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
11281 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
11282 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
11283
11284 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
11285 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011286 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011287 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
11288 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011289 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011290
11291 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
11292 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
11293 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
11294 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
11295
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011296 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
11297 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010011298 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
11299
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011300 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
11301
11302
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011303timeout http-request <timeout>
11304 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
11305 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011306 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011307 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011308 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011309 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11310 as explained at the top of this document.
11311
11312 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
11313 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
11314 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
11315 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
11316 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
11317 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
11318 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020011319 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
11320 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
11321 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
11322 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011323 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011324 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
11325 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011326
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011327 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
11328 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
11329 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
11330 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
11331 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011332 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011333
11334 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
11335 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011336 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011337 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
11338 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
11339
11340 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011341 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
11342 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
11343 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011344
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011345 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011346 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011347
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011348
11349timeout queue <timeout>
11350 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
11351 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11352 yes | no | yes | yes
11353 Arguments :
11354 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11355 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11356 as explained at the top of this document.
11357
11358 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
11359 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
11360 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
11361 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
11362 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
11363
11364 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
11365 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
11366 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
11367 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
11368
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011369 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011370
11371
11372timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011373 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
11374 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11375 yes | no | yes | yes
11376 Arguments :
11377 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11378 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11379 as explained at the top of this document.
11380
11381 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11382 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11383 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
11384 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
11385 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
11386 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
11387 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
11388
11389 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11390 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11391 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
11392 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
11393 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011394 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011395 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011396 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
11397 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011398 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
11399 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011400
11401 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11402 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11403 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11404 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011405 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011406 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11407
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011408 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011409
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011410
11411timeout server-fin <timeout>
11412 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
11413 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11414 yes | no | yes | yes
11415 Arguments :
11416 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11417 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11418 as explained at the top of this document.
11419
11420 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11421 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11422 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11423 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11424 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
11425 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11426 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
11427 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
11428 situations, it should not be needed.
11429
11430 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11431 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11432 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
11433
11434 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
11435
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011436
11437timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011438 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011439 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11440 yes | yes | yes | yes
11441 Arguments :
11442 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
11443 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11444 as explained at the top of this document.
11445
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020011446 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
11447 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
11448 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011449
11450 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11451 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11452 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
11453 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011454 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011455
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011456 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011457
11458
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011459timeout tunnel <timeout>
11460 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
11461 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11462 yes | no | yes | yes
11463 Arguments :
11464 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11465 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11466 as explained at the top of this document.
11467
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011468 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011469 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
11470 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
11471 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011472 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
11473 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011474 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
11475 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
11476 specified.
11477
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011478 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
11479 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
11480 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
11481 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
11482 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
11483 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
11484 state.
11485
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011486 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11487 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11488 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
11489 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011490 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011491
11492 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11493 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11494 forget about it.
11495
11496 Example :
11497 defaults http
11498 option http-server-close
11499 timeout connect 5s
11500 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011501 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011502 timeout server 30s
11503 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
11504
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011505 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011506
11507
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011508transparent (deprecated)
11509 Enable client-side transparent proxying
11510 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010011511 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011512 Arguments : none
11513
11514 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
11515 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
11516 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
11517 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
11518 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
11519 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
11520 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
11521 appropriate server.
11522
11523 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
11524
11525 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
11526 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
11527
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011528 See also: "option transparent"
11529
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011530unique-id-format <string>
11531 Generate a unique ID for each request.
11532 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11533 yes | yes | yes | no
11534 Arguments :
11535 <string> is a log-format string.
11536
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011537 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
11538 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
11539 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
11540 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011541
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011542 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
11543 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
11544 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
11545 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
11546 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
11547 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
11548 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
11549 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011550
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011551 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
11552 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011553
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011554 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011555
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011556 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011557
11558 will generate:
11559
11560 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11561
11562 See also: "unique-id-header"
11563
11564unique-id-header <name>
11565 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
11566 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11567 yes | yes | yes | no
11568 Arguments :
11569 <name> is the name of the header.
11570
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011571 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
11572 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011573
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011574 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011575
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011576 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011577 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
11578
11579 will generate:
11580
11581 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11582
11583 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011584
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011585use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011586 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011587 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11588 no | yes | yes | no
11589 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011590 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
11591 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011592
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011593 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
11594 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011595
11596 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
11597 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
11598 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011599 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011600 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011601 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
11602 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011603
11604 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
11605 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
11606 assign the backend.
11607
11608 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
11609 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11610 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
11611 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
11612 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
11613 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
11614
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011615 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011616 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011617 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
11618 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
11619 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
11620
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011621 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
11622 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
11623 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
11624 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
11625 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
11626 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
11627 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
11628 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
11629 cannot be forced from the request.
11630
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011631 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011632 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
11633 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
11634
11635 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
11636 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011637
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020011638use-fcgi-app <name>
11639 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
11640 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11641 no | no | yes | yes
11642 Arguments :
11643 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
11644
11645 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011646
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011647use-server <server> if <condition>
11648use-server <server> unless <condition>
11649 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
11650 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11651 no | no | yes | yes
11652 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020011653 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
11654 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011655
11656 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
11657
11658 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
11659 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
11660 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
11661
11662 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
11663 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
11664 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
11665 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
11666 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
11667 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
11668 matches will assign the server.
11669
11670 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
11671 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
11672 with the next rules until one matches.
11673
11674 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
11675 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11676 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
11677 according to other persistence mechanisms.
11678
11679 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
11680 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
11681 stripped.
11682
11683 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
11684 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
11685 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
11686 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
11687
11688 Example :
11689 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
11690 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
11691 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
11692 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
11693 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
11694 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000011695 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011696 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
11697 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
11698
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020011699 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
11700 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
11701 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
11702 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
11703 was conditionned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
11704 and we fall back to load balancing.
11705
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011706 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011707
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011708
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100117095. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011710--------------------------
11711
11712The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
11713depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
11714settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
11715written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
11716described in this section.
11717
11718
117195.1. Bind options
11720-----------------
11721
11722The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
11723as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
11724no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
11725parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
11726while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
11727provided immediately after the setting name.
11728
11729The currently supported settings are the following ones.
11730
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011731accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
11732 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
11733 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
11734 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
11735 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
11736 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
11737 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
11738 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
11739 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
11740 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011741 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
11742 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
11743 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011744
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011745accept-proxy
11746 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020011747 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
11748 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011749 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
11750 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
11751 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
11752 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011753 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011754 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
11755 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011756 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
11757 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011758
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011759allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010011760 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011761 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011762 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011763 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
11764 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011765
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011766alpn <protocols>
11767 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11768 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11769 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011770 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011771 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011772 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
11773 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11774 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
11775 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
11776 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
11777 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
11778 preference, like below :
11779
11780 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011781
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011782backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010011783 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011784 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
11785
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010011786curves <curves>
11787 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11788 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
11789 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
11790 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
11791 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
11792 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
11793
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011794ecdhe <named curve>
11795 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010011796 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
11797 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011798
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011799ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011800 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11801 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11802 client's certificate.
11803
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011804ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
11805 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11806 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
11807 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
11808 error is ignored.
11809
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011810ca-sign-file <cafile>
11811 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11812 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
11813 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
11814 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11815 'generate-certificates' for details.
11816
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000011817ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011818 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
11819 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
11820 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11821 'generate-certificates' for details.
11822
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010011823ca-verify-file <cafile>
11824 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
11825 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
11826 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
11827 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
11828 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
11829
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011830ciphers <ciphers>
11831 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11832 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000011833 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011834 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011835 information and recommendations see e.g.
11836 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11837 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11838 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
11839
11840ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11841 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11842 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
11843 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
11844 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011845 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
11846 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011847
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011848crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011849 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11850 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11851 to verify client's certificate.
11852
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011853crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011854 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11855 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
11856 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
11857 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
11858 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010011859 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
11860 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011861
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010011862 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
11863 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
11864
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011865 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
11866 are loaded.
11867
11868 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010011869 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
11870 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
11871 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
11872 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
11873 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
11874 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
11875 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011876 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011877
11878 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
11879 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
11880 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
11881 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011882 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
11883 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011884
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020011885 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011886
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011887 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011888 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011889 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
11890 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011891 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
11892 clients).
11893
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020011894 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
11895 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
11896 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
11897 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
11898 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
11899 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
11900 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
11901 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
11902 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
11903 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
11904 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
11905 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
11906 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
11907
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011908 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
11909 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
11910 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
11911 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
11912 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
11913
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011914 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
11915 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
11916 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
11917 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011918
11919 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
11920 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
11921 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
11922 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
11923 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
11924 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
11925 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
11926 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
11927 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
11928
11929 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
11930
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011931 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011932 a cert bundle.
11933
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011934 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011935 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
11936 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
11937 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
11938 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
11939 provide multi-cert support.
11940
11941 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
11942
11943 Filename | CN | SAN
11944 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11945 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011946 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011947 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
11948 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11949
11950 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
11951 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
11952 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
11953 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011954 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
11955 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
11956 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011957
11958 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
11959 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
11960
11961 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
11962 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
11963 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
11964
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011965crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011966 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011967 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011968 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011969 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011970
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011971crt-list <file>
11972 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011973 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11974 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011975
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011976 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11977
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010011978 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
11979 "no-ca-names", "crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With
11980 BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also
11981 supported. It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011982
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011983 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
11984 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
11985 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11986 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11987 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11988 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11989 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11990 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011991
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011992 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011993 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011994 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11995 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11996 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011997
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011998 crt-list file example:
11999 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012000 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012001 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012002 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012003
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012004defer-accept
12005 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12006 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
12007 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012008 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012009 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
12010 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
12011 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
12012 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
12013 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
12014 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
12015 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
12016
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012017expose-fd listeners
12018 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
12019 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020012020 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
12021 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012022 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012023
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012024force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012025 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012026 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012027 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012028 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012029
12030force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012031 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012032 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012033 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012034
12035force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012036 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012037 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012038 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012039
12040force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012041 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012042 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012043 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012044
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012045force-tlsv13
12046 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
12047 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012048 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012049
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012050generate-certificates
12051 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12052 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
12053 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
12054 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
12055 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
12056 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
12057 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
12058 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
12059 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
12060 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
12061 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
12062
12063 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
12064 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012065 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012066 certificate is used many times.
12067
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012068gid <gid>
12069 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
12070 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12071 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
12072 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
12073 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12074
12075group <group>
12076 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
12077 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
12078 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
12079 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
12080 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12081
12082id <id>
12083 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
12084 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
12085 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
12086 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
12087
12088interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010012089 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
12090 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
12091 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
12092 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
12093 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
12094 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010012095 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
12096 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
12097 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
12098 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
12099 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
12100 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012101
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012102level <level>
12103 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
12104 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
12105 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012106 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012107 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
12108 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
12109 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012110 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012111 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012112 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012113 all counters).
12114
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020012115severity-output <format>
12116 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
12117 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
12118 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
12119 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
12120 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
12121 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
12122 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
12123 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
12124 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
12125 rfc5424 convention.
12126
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012127maxconn <maxconn>
12128 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
12129 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
12130 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
12131 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
12132 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
12133 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
12134 eat all memory.
12135
12136mode <mode>
12137 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
12138 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
12139 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
12140 UNIX sockets.
12141
12142mss <maxseg>
12143 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
12144 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
12145 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
12146 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
12147 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
12148 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
12149 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
12150 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
12151 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
12152 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
12153 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
12154
12155name <name>
12156 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
12157 page.
12158
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012159namespace <name>
12160 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12161 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
12162 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12163 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12164
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012165nice <nice>
12166 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
12167 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
12168 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
12169 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
12170 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
12171 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
12172 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
12173 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
12174 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
12175 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
12176 one for an RDP socket.
12177
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020012178no-ca-names
12179 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12180 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012181 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020012182
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012183no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012184 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012185 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012186 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012187 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012188 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
12189 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012190
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020012191no-tls-tickets
12192 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12193 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12194 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012195 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
12196 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012197 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12198 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12199 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020012200
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012201no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012202 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012203 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012204 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012205 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012206 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12207 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012208
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012209no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012210 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012211 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012212 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012213 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012214 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12215 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012216
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012217no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012218 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012219 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012220 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012221 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012222 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12223 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012224
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012225no-tlsv13
12226 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12227 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
12228 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
12229 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012230 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12231 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012232
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020012233npn <protocols>
12234 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12235 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12236 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012237 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012238 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012239 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12240 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
12241 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
12242 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
12243 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020012244
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000012245prefer-client-ciphers
12246 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
12247 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
12248 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020012249 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
12250 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
12251 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000012252
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012253process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010012254 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012255 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012256 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012257 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
12258 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
12259 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
12260 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012261 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010012262 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
12263 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
12264 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
12265 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
12266 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012267
12268 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
12269
12270 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
12271 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
12272 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
12273 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
12274 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
12275 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
12276 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
12277 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020012278
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012279proto <name>
12280 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
12281 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
12282 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
12283 in haproxy -vv.
12284 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12285 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080012286 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012287 h2" on the bind line.
12288
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012289ssl
12290 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012291 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012292 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
12293 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020012294 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
12295 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012296
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012297ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12298 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
12299 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
12300 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12301
12302ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12303 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
12304 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
12305 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12306
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010012307strict-sni
12308 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
12309 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
12310 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
12311 See the "crt" option for more information.
12312
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012313tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012314 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012315 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
12316 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012317 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012318 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
12319 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
12320 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
12321 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
12322 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
12323 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
12324 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12325
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012326tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010012327 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012328 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
12329 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
12330 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
12331 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
12332 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
12333 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
12334 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020012335 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
12336 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
12337 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012338
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012339tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
12340 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010012341 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
12342 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
12343 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
12344 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
12345 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
12346 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
12347 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
12348 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
12349 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
12350 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012351 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
12352 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
12353
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012354transparent
12355 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12356 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
12357 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
12358 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
12359 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
12360 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
12361 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
12362 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
12363 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
12364 so check for support with your vendor.
12365
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012366v4v6
12367 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12368 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
12369 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
12370 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012371 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012372
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012373v6only
12374 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12375 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
12376 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012377 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
12378 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012379
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012380uid <uid>
12381 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
12382 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12383 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
12384 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
12385 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12386
12387user <user>
12388 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
12389 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12390 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
12391 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
12392 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12393
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012394verify [none|optional|required]
12395 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
12396 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
12397 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
12398 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
12399 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012400 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
12401 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
12402 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
12403 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012404
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200124055.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010012406------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012407
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012408The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
12409which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
12410arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
12411settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
12412after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
12413Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
12414address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012415
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012416 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012417 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012418
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012419Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
12420keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
12421
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012422The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012423
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012424addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012425 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010012426 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
12427 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
12428 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
12429 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
12430 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012431
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012432agent-check
12433 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012434 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010012435 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
12436 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
12437 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012438
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012439 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012440 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020012441 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
12442 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
12443 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012444
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012445 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
12446 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
12447 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
12448 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
12449 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020012450
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012451 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012452 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012453
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012454 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12455 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
12456 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012457
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012458 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12459 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
12460 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012461
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012462 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
12463 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
12464 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
12465 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
12466 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012467 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012468 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012469
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012470 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
12471 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012472
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012473 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
12474 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
12475 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
12476 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
12477 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
12478 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
12479 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
12480 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
12481 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012482
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012483 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
12484 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012485 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
12486 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
12487 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010012488 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012489
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012490 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012491 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012492
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070012493agent-send <string>
12494 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
12495 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
12496 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
12497 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
12498 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
12499
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012500agent-inter <delay>
12501 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
12502 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12503
12504 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
12505 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
12506 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
12507 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
12508 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12509 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12510 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12511 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12512 of backends use the same servers.
12513
12514 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
12515
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010012516agent-addr <addr>
12517 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
12518
12519 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
12520 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
12521 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
12522 hostname, it will be resolved.
12523
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012524agent-port <port>
12525 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
12526
12527 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
12528
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012529allow-0rtt
12530 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020012531 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
12532 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012533
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012534alpn <protocols>
12535 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12536 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12537 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012538 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012539 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
12540 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
12541 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12542 now obsolete NPN extension.
12543 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
12544 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
12545
12546 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
12547
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012548backup
12549 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
12550 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
12551 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
12552 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012553 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
12554 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012555
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012556ca-file <cafile>
12557 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12558 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12559 server's certificate.
12560
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012561check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020012562 This option enables health checks on a server:
12563 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
12564 considered available.
12565 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
12566 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
12567 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
12568 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
12569 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
12570 set.
12571 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
12572 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
12573 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
12574 exchanges succeed.
12575
12576 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
12577 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
12578 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
12579 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
12580 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
12581 parameters are not reused. One must explicitely set "check-send-proxy" to send
12582 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
12583
12584 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
12585 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
12586
12587 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
12588 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
12589
12590 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
12591 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
12592 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
12593 available.
12594
12595 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
12596 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
12597 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
12598
12599 Example:
12600 # simple tcp check
12601 backend foo
12602 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
12603 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
12604 backend foo
12605 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
12606 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
12607 backend foo
12608 option tcp-check
12609 tcp-check connect
12610 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012611
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020012612check-send-proxy
12613 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
12614 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
12615 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
12616 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
12617 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
12618 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
12619 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
12620
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010012621check-alpn <protocols>
12622 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
12623 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
12624 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
12625
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020012626check-proto <name>
12627 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
12628 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
12629 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
12630 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv.
12631 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12632 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
12633 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
12634
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012635check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012636 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012637 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
12638 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012639
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012640check-ssl
12641 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
12642 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
12643 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
12644 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012645 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012646 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
12647 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012648 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012649 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
12650 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012651
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012652check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012653 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012654 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
12655 for normal traffic.
12656
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012657ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012658 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
12659 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
12660 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012661 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
12662 information and recommendations see e.g.
12663 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12664 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12665 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012666
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012667ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12668 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12669 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
12670 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
12671 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012672 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
12673 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
12674 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012675
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012676cookie <value>
12677 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
12678 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
12679 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
12680 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
12681 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
12682 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
12683 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
12684
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012685crl-file <crlfile>
12686 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12687 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12688 to verify server's certificate.
12689
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020012690crt <cert>
12691 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12692 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
12693 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
12694 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
12695 certificate request.
12696
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012697disabled
12698 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
12699 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
12700 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
12701 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
12702 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012703 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012704
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012705enabled
12706 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
12707 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
12708 default value.
12709 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
12710 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012711
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012712error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010012713 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
12714 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
12715 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012716
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012717 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012718
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012719fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012720 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
12721 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
12722 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
12723
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012724force-sslv3
12725 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12726 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012727 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012728 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012729
12730force-tlsv10
12731 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012732 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012733 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012734
12735force-tlsv11
12736 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012737 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012738 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012739
12740force-tlsv12
12741 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012742 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012743 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012744
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012745force-tlsv13
12746 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12747 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012748 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012749
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012750id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020012751 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
12752 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
12753 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012754
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012755init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
12756 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
12757 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012758 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012759 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
12760 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
12761 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
12762 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
12763 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
12764 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
12765 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
12766 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
12767 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012768 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012769 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
12770 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
12771 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
12772 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
12773 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
12774 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012775 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012776
12777 Example:
12778 defaults
12779 # never fail on address resolution
12780 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
12781
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012782inter <delay>
12783fastinter <delay>
12784downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012785 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
12786 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12787 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
12788 between checks depending on the server state :
12789
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020012790 Server state | Interval used
12791 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12792 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
12793 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12794 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
12795 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
12796 or yet unchecked. |
12797 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12798 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
12799 | "inter" otherwise.
12800 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012801
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012802 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
12803 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
12804 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
12805 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012806 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12807 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12808 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12809 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12810 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012811
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012812maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012813 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
12814 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012815 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
12816 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012817 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
12818 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
12819 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
12820 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
12821
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012822 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
12823 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
12824 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
12825 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
12826 than 50 concurrent requests.
12827
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012828maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012829 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
12830 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
12831 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
12832 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
12833 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
12834 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
12835 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
12836
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010012837max-reuse <count>
12838 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
12839 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
12840 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
12841 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
12842 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
12843 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
12844 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
12845 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
12846
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012847minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012848 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
12849 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
12850 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
12851 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
12852 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
12853 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012854 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012855 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012856
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012857namespace <name>
12858 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12859 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
12860 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12861 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12862
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012863no-agent-check
12864 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
12865 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12866 default value.
12867 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12868 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
12869
12870no-backup
12871 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
12872 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12873 default value.
12874 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12875 "default-server" "backup" setting.
12876
12877no-check
12878 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
12879 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12880 default value.
12881 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12882 "default-server" "check" setting.
12883
12884no-check-ssl
12885 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
12886 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12887 default value.
12888 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12889 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
12890
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012891no-send-proxy
12892 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
12893 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12894 default value.
12895 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12896 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
12897
12898no-send-proxy-v2
12899 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
12900 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12901 default value.
12902 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12903 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
12904
12905no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
12906 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
12907 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12908 default value.
12909 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12910 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
12911
12912no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12913 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
12914 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12915 default value.
12916 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12917 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
12918
12919no-ssl
12920 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
12921 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12922 default value.
12923 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12924 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
12925
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010012926no-ssl-reuse
12927 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
12928 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
12929 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
12930 and for paranoid users.
12931
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012932no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012933 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12934 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012935 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012936
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012937 Supported in default-server: No
12938
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012939no-tls-tickets
12940 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12941 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12942 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012943 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
12944 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012945 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12946 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12947 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012948 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012949
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012950no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012951 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012952 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12953 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012954 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12955 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012956 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012957
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012958 Supported in default-server: No
12959
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012960no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012961 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012962 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12963 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012964 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12965 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012966 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012967
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012968 Supported in default-server: No
12969
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012970no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012971 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012972 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12973 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012974 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12975 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012976 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012977
12978 Supported in default-server: No
12979
12980no-tlsv13
12981 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12982 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12983 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
12984 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12985 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012986 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012987
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012988 Supported in default-server: No
12989
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012990no-verifyhost
12991 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
12992 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12993 default value.
12994 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12995 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012996
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012997no-tfo
12998 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
12999 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13000 default value.
13001 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13002 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
13003
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090013004non-stick
13005 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
13006 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
13007 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
13008
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013009npn <protocols>
13010 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13011 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13012 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013013 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013014 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
13015 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13016 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
13017
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013018observe <mode>
13019 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
13020 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
13021 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
13022 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
13023 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
13024 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010013025 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013026
13027 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
13028
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013029on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013030 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
13031 Currently, four modes are available:
13032 - fastinter: force fastinter
13033 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
13034 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
13035 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
13036 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
13037
13038 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
13039
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013040on-marked-down <action>
13041 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
13042 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013043 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
13044 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
13045 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
13046 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
13047 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
13048 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
13049 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
13050 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013051
13052 Actions are disabled by default
13053
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013054on-marked-up <action>
13055 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
13056 Currently one action is available:
13057 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
13058 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
13059 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
13060 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013061 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
13062 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013063 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
13064 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
13065
13066 Actions are disabled by default
13067
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010013068pool-max-conn <max>
13069 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
13070 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
13071 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
13072 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
13073 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
13074 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
13075
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013076pool-purge-delay <delay>
13077 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010013078 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020013079 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013080
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013081port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013082 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
13083 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
13084 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
13085 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
13086 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
13087 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
13088
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013089proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013090 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
13091 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
13092 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
13093 reported in haproxy -vv.
13094 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
13095 protocol for all connections established to this server.
13096
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013097redir <prefix>
13098 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
13099 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
13100 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
13101 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
13102 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
13103 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
13104 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
13105 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013106 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013107 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013108 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
13109 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
13110 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
13111 loop between the client and HAProxy!
13112
13113 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
13114
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013115rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013116 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
13117 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
13118 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
13119
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020013120resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
13121 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
13122 server.
13123
13124 Available options:
13125
13126 * allow-dup-ip
13127 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
13128 resolution at runtime is in operation.
13129 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
13130 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
13131 For such case, simply enable this option.
13132 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
13133
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050013134 * ignore-weight
13135 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
13136 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
13137 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
13138
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020013139 * prevent-dup-ip
13140 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
13141 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
13142 same fqdn.
13143 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
13144
13145 Example:
13146 backend b_myapp
13147 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
13148 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
13149 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
13150
13151 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
13152 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
13153 it
13154 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
13155 different address
13156
13157 Default value: not set
13158
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013159resolve-prefer <family>
13160 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
13161 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
13162 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
13163 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
13164
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020013165 Default value: ipv6
13166
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013167 Example:
13168
13169 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013170
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013171resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013172 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013173 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013174 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013175 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
13176 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013177 configured network, another address is selected.
13178
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013179 Example:
13180
13181 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013182
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013183resolvers <id>
13184 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
13185 hostname.
13186
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013187 Example:
13188
13189 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013190
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013191 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013192
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010013193send-proxy
13194 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
13195 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
13196 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
13197 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013198 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
13199 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
13200 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
13201 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
13202 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
13203 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
13204 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
13205 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
13206 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
13207 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013208 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
13209 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010013210
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013211send-proxy-v2
13212 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
13213 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13214 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13215 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020013216 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
13217 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
13218 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
13219 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013220
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010013221proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010013222 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
13223 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
13224
13225 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
13226 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
13227 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
13228 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
13229 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
13230 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
13231 connection is supported).
13232 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
13233 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
13234 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
13235 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
13236 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
13237 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
13238 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010013239
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013240send-proxy-v2-ssl
13241 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
13242 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13243 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13244 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
13245 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
13246 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
13247 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013248 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
13249 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013250
13251send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13252 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
13253 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13254 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13255 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
13256 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
13257 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
13258 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
13259 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013260 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
13261 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013262
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013263slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013264 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
13265 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
13266 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
13267 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
13268 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
13269 parameters :
13270
13271 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
13272 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
13273
13274 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
13275 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
13276 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
13277 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
13278
13279 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
13280 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
13281 seen as failed.
13282
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020013283sni <expression>
13284 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
13285 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
13286 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
13287 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020013288 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
13289 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013290 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010013291 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
13292 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020013293
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013294source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020013295source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013296source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013297 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
13298 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
13299 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
13300 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
13301
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013302 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
13303 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
13304 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
13305 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
13306 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
13307 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
13308 server.
13309
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000013310 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
13311 specifying the source address without port(s).
13312
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013313ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020013314 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
13315 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
13316 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
13317 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
13318 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
13319 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013320 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
13321 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013322
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013323ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13324 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
13325 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
13326 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13327
13328ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13329 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
13330 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
13331 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
13332
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013333ssl-reuse
13334 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
13335 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13336 default value.
13337 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13338 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
13339
13340stick
13341 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
13342 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13343 default value.
13344 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13345 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013346
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013347socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013348 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013349 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
13350 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
13351
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020013352tcp-ut <delay>
13353 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
13354 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
13355 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013356 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020013357 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
13358 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
13359 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
13360 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
13361 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
13362 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
13363 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
13364 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
13365 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13366
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010013367tfo
13368 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
13369 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
13370 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
13371 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
13372 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013373 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010013374
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013375track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020013376 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
13377 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
13378 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
13379 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013380 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
13381
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013382tls-tickets
13383 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
13384 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13385 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013386 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13387 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13388 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013389 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010013390 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013391
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013392verify [none|required]
13393 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010013394 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013395 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
13396 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013397 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013398 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
13399 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
13400 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
13401 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
13402 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
13403 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
13404 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
13405 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013406
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070013407verifyhost <hostname>
13408 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013409 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
13410 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
13411 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
13412 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
13413 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
13414 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
13415 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
13416 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070013417
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013418weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013419 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
13420 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
13421 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020013422 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
13423 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
13424 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
13425 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
13426 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
13427 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013428
13429
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200134305.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
13431-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013432
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013433HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
13434using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
13435configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013436This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
13437can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
13438workload.
13439This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
13440resolution at run time.
13441Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
13442carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
13443
13444
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200134455.3.1. Global overview
13446----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013447
13448As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
13449different steps of the process life:
13450
13451 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
13452 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
13453 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
13454
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013455 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
13456 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013457
13458A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
13459 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
13460 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
13461 resolution to know this new IP.
13462
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013463When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013464HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013465SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
13466from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
13467will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
13468will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020013469
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013470A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013471 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013472 first valid response.
13473
13474 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
13475 servers return an error.
13476
13477
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200134785.3.2. The resolvers section
13479----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013480
13481This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013482HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
13483contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013484
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013485When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
13486uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
13487is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
13488answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
13489
13490When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013491used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013492
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013493 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
13494 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
13495 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013496
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013497 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
13498 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013499
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013500 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
13501 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
13502 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013503
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013504For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
13505following scenarios are possible:
13506
13507 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
13508 ignored
13509
13510 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
13511 applied
13512
13513 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
13514 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
13515
13516 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
13517 retries the query with a new type
13518
13519 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
13520 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013521
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013522As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
13523a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013524<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013525
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013526
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013527resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013528 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013529
13530A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
13531
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013532accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013533 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013534 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013535 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
13536 by RFC 6891)
13537
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020013538 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
13539
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013540nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
13541 DNS server description:
13542 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
13543 <ip> : IP address of the server
13544 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
13545
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013546parse-resolv-conf
13547 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
13548 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
13549 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
13550
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013551hold <status> <period>
13552 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
13553 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013554 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013555 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013556 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
13557 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13558 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
13559
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020013560 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013561
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013562resolve_retries <nb>
13563 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
13564 giving up.
13565 Default value: 3
13566
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013567 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
13568 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
13569 type.
13570
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013571timeout <event> <time>
13572 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
13573 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
13574 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013575 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
13576 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013577 Default value: 1s
13578 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013579 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013580 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013581 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13582 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
13583
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013584 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013585
13586 resolvers mydns
13587 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
13588 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013589 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013590 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013591 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013592 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013593 hold other 30s
13594 hold refused 30s
13595 hold nx 30s
13596 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013597 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013598 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013599
13600
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200136016. Cache
13602---------
13603
13604HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
13605(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
13606RAM.
13607
13608The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
13609this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
13610
13611If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
13612independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
13613when we try to allocate a new one.
13614
13615The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
13616
13617It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
13618"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
13619for more details.
13620
13621When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
13622replaced by "<CACHE>".
13623
13624
136256.1. Limitation
13626----------------
13627
13628The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
13629
13630- If the response is not a 200
13631- If the response contains a Vary header
13632- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
13633- If the response is not cacheable
13634
13635- If the request is not a GET
13636- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
13637- If the request contains an Authorization header
13638
13639
136406.2. Setup
13641-----------
13642
13643To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
13644the corresponding http-request and response actions.
13645
13646
136476.2.1. Cache section
13648---------------------
13649
13650cache <name>
13651 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
13652 size of cache is mandatory.
13653
13654total-max-size <megabytes>
13655 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
13656 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
13657
13658max-object-size <bytes>
13659 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
13660 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
13661 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
13662
13663max-age <seconds>
13664 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
13665 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
13666 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
13667 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
13668 default.
13669
13670
136716.2.2. Proxy section
13672---------------------
13673
13674http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13675 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
13676 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
13677 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
13678 after this one.
13679
13680http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13681 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
13682 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
13683 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
13684 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
13685
13686
13687Example:
13688
13689 backend bck1
13690 mode http
13691
13692 http-request cache-use foobar
13693 http-response cache-store foobar
13694 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
13695
13696 cache foobar
13697 total-max-size 4
13698 max-age 240
13699
13700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200137017. Using ACLs and fetching samples
13702----------------------------------
13703
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013704HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013705client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
13706The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
13707these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
13708but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
13709data called patterns.
13710
13711
137127.1. ACL basics
13713---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013714
13715The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
13716content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
13717from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
13718simple :
13719
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013720 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013721 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013722 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
13723 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013724
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013725The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
13726adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013727
13728In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
13729
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013730 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013731
13732This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
13733Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
13734and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013735an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
13736conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
13737as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
13738are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013739
13740ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
13741'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
13742which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
13743
13744There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
13745performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
13746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013747The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
13748specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
13749this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013750methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
13751ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013752
13753Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
13754 - boolean
13755 - integer (signed or unsigned)
13756 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
13757 - string
13758 - data block
13759
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013760Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
13761converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
13762would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
13763The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
13764which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
13765
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013766Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
13767keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
13768fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
13769which are summarized in the table below :
13770
13771 +---------------------+-----------------+
13772 | Sample or converter | Default |
13773 | output type | matching method |
13774 +---------------------+-----------------+
13775 | boolean | bool |
13776 +---------------------+-----------------+
13777 | integer | int |
13778 +---------------------+-----------------+
13779 | ip | ip |
13780 +---------------------+-----------------+
13781 | string | str |
13782 +---------------------+-----------------+
13783 | binary | none, use "-m" |
13784 +---------------------+-----------------+
13785
13786Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
13787matching method, see below.
13788
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013789The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
13790 - boolean
13791 - integer or integer range
13792 - IP address / network
13793 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
13794 - regular expression
13795 - hex block
13796
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013797The following ACL flags are currently supported :
13798
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013799 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
13800 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013801 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013802 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013803 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013804 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013805 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
13806
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013807The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
13808read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
13809if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
13810lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
13811will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
13812beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
13813a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
13814lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
13815exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
13816
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013817The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
13818parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
13819ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
13820a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
13821check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
13822
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013823The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
13824socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
13825file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
13826
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013827Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
13828loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
13829
13830 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
13831
13832In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
13833the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
13834case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
13835as well.
13836
13837The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
13838sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
13839do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
13840methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
13841is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013842obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013843followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
13844default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
13845that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
13846string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
13847
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013848The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
13849By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
13850string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
13851resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
13852server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013853waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013854flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
13855function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
13856
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013857There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
13858sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
13859be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013860
13861 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
13862 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013863 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
13864 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
13865 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
13866 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013867
13868 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
13869 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013870 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013871
13872 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013873 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013874
13875 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013876 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013877
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013878 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013879 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
13880
13881 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
13882 binary or string samples.
13883
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013884 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
13885 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013886
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013887 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
13888 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
13889 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013890
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013891 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
13892 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013893
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013894 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
13895 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013896
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013897 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
13898 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013900 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
13901 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013902 This may be used with binary or string samples.
13903
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013904 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
13905 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
13906 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013907
13908For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
13909request, it is possible to do :
13910
13911 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
13912
13913In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
13914buffer, one would use the following acl :
13915
13916 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
13917
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013918On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
13919possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
13920
13921 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
13922
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013923All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
13924criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
13925method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
13926to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
13927criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
13928the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013929
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013930If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013931the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
13932For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013933
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013934 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
13935 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
13936 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
13937 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013938
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013939
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013940The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
13941types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
13942combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
13943brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
13944default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013946 +-------------------------------------------------+
13947 | Input sample type |
13948 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013949 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013950 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13951 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
13952 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013953 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013954 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013955 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013956 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013957 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013958 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013959 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013960 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013961 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013962 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013963 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013964 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013965 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013966 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013967 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013968 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013969 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013970 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013971 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013972 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013973 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013974 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13975 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
13976 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013977
13978
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200139797.1.1. Matching booleans
13980------------------------
13981
13982In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
13983Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
13984When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
13985that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
13986
13987Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
13988return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
13989"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
13990
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200139927.1.2. Matching integers
13993------------------------
13994
13995Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
13996enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
13997to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
13998
13999Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
14000matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
14001lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014002
14003For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
14004unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
14005representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
14006
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014007As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
14008two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
14009instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
14010ranges and operators.
14011
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014012For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014013operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
14014Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
14015of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014016
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014017Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014018
14019 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
14020 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
14021 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
14022 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
14023 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
14024
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014025For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014026
14027 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
14028
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014029This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
14030
14031 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
14032
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200140347.1.3. Matching strings
14035-----------------------
14036
14037String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
14038different forms :
14039
14040 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014041 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014042
14043 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014044 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014045
14046 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
14047 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14048
14049 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
14050 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14051
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010014052 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014053 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
14054 matches.
14055
14056 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
14057 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
14058 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014059
14060String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
14061exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
14062characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
14063string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
14064to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014065before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014066
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010014067Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
14068(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
14069Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
14070
14071Example:
14072 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
14073 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
14074
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014075
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200140767.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
14077---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014078
14079Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
14080they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
14081possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
14082passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
14083the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014084the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
14085match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014086
14087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200140887.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
14089-------------------------------------
14090
14091It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
14092not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
14093a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
14094to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
14095digits may be used upper or lower case.
14096
14097Example :
14098 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
14099 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
14100
14101
141027.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
14103---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014104
14105IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
14106netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
14107within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010014108host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014109difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
14110at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
14111does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
14112parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014113
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020014114The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
14115abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
14116
14117 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14118 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
14119 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14120 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
14121 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
14122 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
14123 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
14124 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14125
14126Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
14127192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
14128
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014129IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
14130Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
14131trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
14132IPv6 patterns.
14133
14134HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
14135following situations :
14136 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
14137 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
14138 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
14139 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
14140 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
14141 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
14142 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
14143 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
14144 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
14145 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
14146
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014147
141487.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
14149----------------------------------
14150
14151Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
14152combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
14153
14154 - AND (implicit)
14155 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
14156 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014157
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014158A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014159
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014160 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020014161
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014162Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
14163indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020014164
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014165For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
14166"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
14167requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
14168is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
14169
14170 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014171 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
14172 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
14173 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014174
14175To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
14176and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
14177
14178 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
14179 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
14180 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
14181 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
14182
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014183 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014184 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
14185 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
14186 use_backend www if host_www
14187
14188It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
14189expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
14190be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
14191the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
14192
14193 The following rule :
14194
14195 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014196 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014197
14198 Can also be written that way :
14199
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014200 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014201
14202It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
14203to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
14204simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
14205sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
14206good use is the following :
14207
14208 With named ACLs :
14209
14210 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
14211 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
14212 monitor fail if site_dead
14213
14214 With anonymous ACLs :
14215
14216 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
14217
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014218See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
14219keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014220
14221
142227.3. Fetching samples
14223---------------------
14224
14225Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
14226against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
14227sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
14228ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
14229of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
14230available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
14231
14232This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
14233Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
14234compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
14235deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
14236
14237The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
14238matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
14239method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
14240indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
14241
14242As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
14243when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
14244mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
14245the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
14246ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
14247
14248Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
14249multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
14250when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014251incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
14252are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014253is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
14254all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
14255
14256Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
14257 - name
14258 - name(arg1)
14259 - name(arg1,arg2)
14260
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014261
142627.3.1. Converters
14263-----------------
14264
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014265Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
14266of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
14267is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
14268was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014269has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014270unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
14271
14272These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
14273sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
14274the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014275support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014276
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014277A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
14278support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
14279supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
14280(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
14281bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
14282
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014283The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014284
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001428551d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
14286 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
14287 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
14288 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
14289 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
14290 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
14291
14292 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014293 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
14294 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000014295 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
14296 frontend http-in
14297 bind *:8081
14298 default_backend servers
14299 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
14300 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
14301
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014302add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014303 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014304 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014305 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
14306 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014307 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014308 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14309 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14310 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14311 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014312 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014313 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014314
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010014315aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
14316 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
14317 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
14318 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
14319 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
14320 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
14321 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
14322
14323 Example:
14324 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
14325 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
14326
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014327and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014328 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014329 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014330 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14331 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014332 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014333 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14334 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14335 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14336 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014337 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014338 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014339
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020014340b64dec
14341 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
14342 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
14343
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020014344base64
14345 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014346 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020014347 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
14348
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014349bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014350 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014351 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014352 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014353 presence of a flag).
14354
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010014355bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
14356 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
14357 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014358 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010014359
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014360concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
14361 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
14362 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
14363 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
14364 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
14365 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
14366 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
14367 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
14368 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
14369 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
14370 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014371 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
14372 parethesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
14373 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
14374 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014375
14376 Example:
14377 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
14378 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
14379 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014380 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014381 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
14382
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014383cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014384 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
14385 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014386
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010014387crc32([<avalanche>])
14388 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
14389 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14390 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14391 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14392 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14393 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
14394 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
14395 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
14396 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
14397 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014398 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
14399
14400crc32c([<avalanche>])
14401 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
14402 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14403 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14404 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
14405 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
14406 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
14407 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
14408 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010014409
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020014410cut_crlf
14411 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
14412 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
14413 updated.
14414
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010014415da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014416 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
14417 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
14418 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
14419 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000014420 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014421 configuration language.
14422
14423 Example:
14424 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020014425 bind *:8881
14426 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000014427 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014428
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010014429debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
14430 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
14431 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
14432 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
14433 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
14434 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
14435 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
14436 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
14437 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
14438 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
14439 printable sample types.
14440
14441 Example:
14442 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020014443
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014444div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014445 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14446 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014447 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014448 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
14449 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014450 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014451 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14452 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14453 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14454 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014455 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014456 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014457
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014458djb2([<avalanche>])
14459 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
14460 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14461 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14462 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14463 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14464 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14465 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014466 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
14467 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014468
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014469even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014470 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014471 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
14472
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014473field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14474 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
14475 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
14476 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
14477 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
14478 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
14479 fields.
14480
14481 Example :
14482 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
14483 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14484 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
14485 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
14486 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010014487
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014488hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014489 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014490 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014491 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014492 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010014493
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020014494hex2i
14495 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014496 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020014497
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020014498htonl
14499 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
14500 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
14501 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
14502 unsigned 32-bit integer.
14503
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010014504http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014505 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14506 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014507 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
14508 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
14509 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
14510 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
14511 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
14512 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
14513 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
14514 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014515
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014516in_table(<table>)
14517 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14518 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
14519 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014520 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014521 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
14522
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014523ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
14524 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014525 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014526 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
14527 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
14528 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
14529 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
14530 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014531
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014532json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014533 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014534 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014535 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014536 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
14537 of errors:
14538 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
14539 bytes, ...)
14540 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
14541 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
14542
14543 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
14544 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
14545 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
14546 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
14547 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
14548 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014549 - "ascii" : never fails;
14550 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
14551 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014552 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014553 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014554 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
14555 characters corresponding to the other errors.
14556
14557 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014558 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014559
14560 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014561 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014562 capture request header user-agent len 150
14563 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014564
14565 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
14566 GET / HTTP/1.0
14567 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
14568
14569 Output log:
14570 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
14571
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014572language(<value>[,<default>])
14573 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
14574 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
14575 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
14576 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
14577 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
14578 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
14579 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
14580 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
14581 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014582 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014583 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
14584 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014585
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014586 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014587
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014588 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
14589 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014590
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014591 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
14592 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
14593 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
14594 use_backend spanish if es
14595 use_backend french if fr
14596 use_backend english if en
14597 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014598
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010014599length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010014600 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
14601 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14602 type. The result is of type integer.
14603
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014604lower
14605 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
14606 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14607 type. The result is of type string.
14608
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014609ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
14610 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14611 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
14612 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14613 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14614 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14615 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
14616
14617 Example :
14618
14619 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014620 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014621 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14622
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020014623ltrim(<chars>)
14624 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
14625 representation of the input sample.
14626
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014627map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14628map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14629map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14630 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
14631 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
14632 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
14633 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
14634 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
14635 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
14636 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
14637 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014638
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014639 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
14640 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
14641 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014642
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014643 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014644 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014645
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014646 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
14647 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14648 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
14649 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020014650 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
14651 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014652 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
14653 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14654 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
14655 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14656 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
14657 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14658 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
14659 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080014660 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
14661 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14662 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014663 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14664 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
14665 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14666 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
14667 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014668
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010014669 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
14670 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
14671 the corresponding match text.
14672
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014673 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
14674 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
14675 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
14676 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
14677 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014678
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014679 Example :
14680
14681 # this is a comment and is ignored
14682 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
14683 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
14684 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
14685 | | | `---------- value
14686 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
14687 | `---------------------------- key
14688 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
14689
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014690mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014691 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14692 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014693 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014694 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014695 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014696 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14697 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14698 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14699 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014700 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014701 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014702
14703mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014704 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020014705 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
14706 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014707 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014708 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014709 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014710 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14711 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14712 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14713 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014714 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014715 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014716
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010014717nbsrv
14718 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
14719 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
14720 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
14721 map lookup.
14722
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014723neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014724 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
14725 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
14726 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
14727 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014728
14729not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014730 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014731 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014732 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014733 absence of a flag).
14734
14735odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014736 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014737 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
14738
14739or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014740 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014741 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014742 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14743 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014744 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014745 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14746 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14747 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14748 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014749 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014750 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014751
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014752protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
14753 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
14754 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
14755 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
14756 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
14757 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14758 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14759 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14760 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
14761 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
14762 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14763 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
14764
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010014765regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014766 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
14767 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
14768 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
14769 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
14770 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
14771 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
14772 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
14773 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
14774 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014775 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
14776 of characters with other ones.
14777
14778 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
14779 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
14780 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
14781 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
14782 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
14783 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014784
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010014785 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014786
14787 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
14788 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
14789 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014790 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014791
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010014792 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
14793 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
14794
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010014795 # capture groups and backreferences
14796 # both lines do the same.
14797 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)]'
14798 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
14799
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014800capture-req(<id>)
14801 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
14802 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14803
14804 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014805 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14806 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014807
14808capture-res(<id>)
14809 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
14810 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14811
14812 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014813 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14814 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014815
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020014816rtrim(<chars>)
14817 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
14818 of the input sample.
14819
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014820sdbm([<avalanche>])
14821 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
14822 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14823 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14824 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14825 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14826 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14827 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014828 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
14829 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014830
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014831set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014832 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
14833 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
14834 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014835 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014836 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14837 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014838 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014839 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14840 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014841 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014842 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014843
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020014844sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020014845 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020014846 sample with length of 20 bytes.
14847
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020014848sha2([<bits>])
14849 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
14850 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
14851
14852 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
14853 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
14854
14855 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
14856 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
14857
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020014858srv_queue
14859 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
14860 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
14861 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
14862 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
14863 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
14864
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020014865strcmp(<var>)
14866 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
14867 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
14868 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
14869 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
14870 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
14871 shorter).
14872
14873 Example :
14874
14875 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
14876 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
14877 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
14878
14879
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014880sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014881 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
14882 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014883 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014884 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
14885 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014886 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014887 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14888 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014889 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014890 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14891 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014892 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014893 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014894
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014895table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
14896 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14897 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14898 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
14899 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14900 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14901 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
14902
14903
14904table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
14905 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14906 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14907 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
14908 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14909 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14910 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
14911
14912table_conn_cnt(<table>)
14913 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14914 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014915 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014916 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
14917 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14918
14919table_conn_cur(<table>)
14920 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14921 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14922 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14923 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14924 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
14925
14926table_conn_rate(<table>)
14927 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14928 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14929 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
14930 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14931 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
14932
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014933table_gpt0(<table>)
14934 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14935 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
14936 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14937 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14938 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
14939
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014940table_gpc0(<table>)
14941 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14942 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14943 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14944 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14945 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
14946
14947table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
14948 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14949 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14950 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
14951 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14952 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
14953 sample fetch keyword.
14954
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014955table_gpc1(<table>)
14956 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14957 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14958 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
14959 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14960 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
14961
14962table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
14963 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14964 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14965 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
14966 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14967 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
14968 sample fetch keyword.
14969
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014970table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
14971 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14972 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014973 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014974 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14975 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14976
14977table_http_err_rate(<table>)
14978 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14979 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14980 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
14981 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
14982 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
14983 keyword.
14984
14985table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
14986 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14987 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014988 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014989 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
14990 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14991
14992table_http_req_rate(<table>)
14993 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14994 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14995 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
14996 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
14997 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
14998 keyword.
14999
15000table_kbytes_in(<table>)
15001 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15002 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015003 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015004 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
15005 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
15006 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
15007 keyword.
15008
15009table_kbytes_out(<table>)
15010 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15011 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015012 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015013 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
15014 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
15015 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
15016 keyword.
15017
15018table_server_id(<table>)
15019 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15020 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15021 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
15022 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
15023 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
15024 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
15025
15026table_sess_cnt(<table>)
15027 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15028 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015029 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015030 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
15031 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
15032 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
15033 keyword.
15034
15035table_sess_rate(<table>)
15036 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15037 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15038 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
15039 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
15040 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
15041 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
15042 keyword.
15043
15044table_trackers(<table>)
15045 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15046 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15047 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
15048 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
15049 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
15050 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
15051 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
15052 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
15053 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
15054 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
15055
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015056upper
15057 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
15058 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15059 type. The result is of type string.
15060
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020015061url_dec([<in_form>])
15062 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
15063 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
15064 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
15065 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
15066 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
15067 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020015068
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015069ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015070 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015071 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
15072 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
15073 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015074 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15075 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15076 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15077 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015078 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015079 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15080 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015081
15082 Example:
15083 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
15084 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
15085
15086 message Point {
15087 int32 latitude = 1;
15088 int32 longitude = 2;
15089 }
15090
15091 message PPoint {
15092 Point point = 59;
15093 }
15094
15095 message Rectangle {
15096 // One corner of the rectangle.
15097 PPoint lo = 48;
15098 // The other corner of the rectangle.
15099 PPoint hi = 49;
15100 }
15101
15102 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
15103 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
15104 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
15105
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015106 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
15107 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015108 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015109 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
15110
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015111 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015112
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015113 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015114
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015115 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015116 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
15117 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
15118
15119 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
15120 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
15121 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
15122
15123 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
15124 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
15125 interpret the previous binary sample.
15126
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015127
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010015128unset-var(<var name>)
15129 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
15130 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
15131 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
15132 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15133 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
15134 response),
15135 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15136 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
15137 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
15138 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
15139
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015140utime(<format>[,<offset>])
15141 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15142 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
15143 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
15144 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
15145 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
15146 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
15147
15148 Example :
15149
15150 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015151 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015152 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15153
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015154word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15155 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
15156 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
15157 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010015158 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015159 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
15160 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
15161
15162 Example :
15163 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
15164 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15165 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
15166 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
15167 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010015168 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010015169
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015170wt6([<avalanche>])
15171 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
15172 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15173 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15174 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15175 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15176 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15177 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015178 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
15179 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015180
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015181xor(<value>)
15182 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015183 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015184 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015185 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015186 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015187 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15188 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015189 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015190 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15191 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015192 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015193 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015194
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010015195xxh32([<seed>])
15196 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
15197 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
15198 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
15199 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
15200 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
15201 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
15202 as cryptographically secure.
15203
15204xxh64([<seed>])
15205 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
15206 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
15207 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
15208 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
15209 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
15210 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
15211 as cryptographically secure.
15212
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015213
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200152147.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015215--------------------------------------------
15216
15217A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
15218not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
15219"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
15220The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
15221
15222always_false : boolean
15223 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
15224 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
15225
15226always_true : boolean
15227 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
15228 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
15229
15230avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015231 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015232 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
15233 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
15234 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
15235 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
15236 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
15237 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
15238 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
15239 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
15240 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
15241 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
15242 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
15243 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
15244 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010015245
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015246be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015247 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
15248 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
15249 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
15250 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040015251 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
15252
15253be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
15254 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
15255 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
15256 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
15257 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
15258 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040015259 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
15260 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040015261
15262 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
15263 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
15264 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015265
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015266be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
15267 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15268 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
15269 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015270 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015271 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
15272 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015273
15274 Example :
15275 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
15276 backend dynamic
15277 mode http
15278 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
15279 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015280
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015281bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015282 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
15283 of the string.
15284
15285bool(<bool>) : bool
15286 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
15287 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
15288
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015289connslots([<backend>]) : integer
15290 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015291 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015292 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
15293 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050015294
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015295 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015296 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015297 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
15298
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015299 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
15300 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015301
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015302 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015303 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015304 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015305 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015306 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015307 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015308 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015309
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015310 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
15311 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015312 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015313 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015314
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010015315cpu_calls : integer
15316 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
15317 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
15318 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
15319 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
15320 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
15321 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
15322
15323cpu_ns_avg : integer
15324 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
15325 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
15326 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
15327 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
15328 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
15329 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
15330 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
15331 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
15332 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
15333 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
15334 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
15335
15336cpu_ns_tot : integer
15337 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
15338 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
15339 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
15340 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
15341 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
15342 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
15343 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
15344 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
15345 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
15346 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
15347 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
15348 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
15349 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
15350
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010015351date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020015352 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015353
15354 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
15355 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
15356 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020015357 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
15358
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015359 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
15360 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
15361 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
15362 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
15363 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
15364
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020015365 Example :
15366
15367 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
15368 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020015369
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015370 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
15371 # millisecond granularity
15372 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
15373
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010015374date_us : integer
15375 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
15376 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
15377 from the same timeval structure.
15378
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020015379distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
15380 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
15381 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
15382 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
15383 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
15384 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
15385 list of supported tokens.
15386
15387distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
15388 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
15389 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
15390 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
15391 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
15392 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
15393 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
15394 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
15395 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
15396 supported tokens.
15397
15398 Example :
15399 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
15400 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
15401 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
15402 # send large files to the big farm
15403 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
15404
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020015405env(<name>) : string
15406 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
15407 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
15408 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
15409 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
15410 certain way.
15411
15412 Examples :
15413 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
15414 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
15415
15416 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
15417 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
15418
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015419fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
15420 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015421 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
15422 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015423 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
15424 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015425 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015426 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
15427 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015428
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020015429fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
15430 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
15431 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
15432 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
15433
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015434fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
15435 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15436 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
15437 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
15438 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
15439 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
15440 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
15441 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
15442 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015443
15444 Example :
15445 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
15446 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
15447 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
15448 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
15449 frontend mail
15450 bind :25
15451 mode tcp
15452 maxconn 100
15453 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
15454 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
15455 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
15456 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015457
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010015458hostname : string
15459 Returns the system hostname.
15460
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015461int(<integer>) : signed integer
15462 Returns a signed integer.
15463
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015464ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
15465 Returns an ipv4.
15466
15467ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
15468 Returns an ipv6.
15469
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010015470lat_ns_avg : integer
15471 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
15472 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
15473 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
15474 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
15475 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
15476 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
15477 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
15478 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
15479 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
15480 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
15481 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
15482 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
15483 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
15484 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
15485
15486lat_ns_tot : integer
15487 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
15488 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
15489 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
15490 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
15491 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
15492 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
15493 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
15494 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
15495 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
15496 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
15497 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
15498 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
15499 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
15500 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
15501 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
15502 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
15503 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
15504 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
15505 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
15506
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015507meth(<method>) : method
15508 Returns a method.
15509
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015510nbproc : integer
15511 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
15512 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
15513 and debugging purposes.
15514
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015515nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
15516 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
15517 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
15518 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015519 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
15520 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
15521 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015522
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040015523prio_class : integer
15524 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
15525 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
15526 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
15527
15528prio_offset : integer
15529 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
15530 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
15531 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
15532 set-priority-offset".
15533
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015534proc : integer
15535 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
15536 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
15537 debugging purposes.
15538
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015539queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015540 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
15541 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
15542 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015543 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
15544 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
15545 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
15546 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
15547 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
15548
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010015549rand([<range>]) : integer
15550 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
15551 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
15552 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
15553 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
15554 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
15555
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020015556uuid([<version>]) : string
15557 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
15558 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
15559 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
15560
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015561srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15562 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15563 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
15564 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
15565 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
15566 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040015567 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
15568 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
15569
15570srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15571 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
15572 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
15573 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15574 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
15575 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
15576 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
15577 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
15578
15579 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
15580 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015581
15582srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
15583 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
15584 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
15585 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015586 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015587 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
15588 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
15589 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
15590
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020015591srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15592 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
15593 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15594 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
15595 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
15596 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
15597 fetch methods.
15598
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015599srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15600 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15601 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015602 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015603 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
15604 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015605 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015606 overloading servers).
15607
15608 Example :
15609 # Redirect to a separate back
15610 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
15611 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
15612 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
15613
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015614stopping : boolean
15615 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
15616 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
15617 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
15618
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015619str(<string>) : string
15620 Returns a string.
15621
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015622table_avl([<table>]) : integer
15623 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
15624 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
15625
15626table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15627 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
15628 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
15629 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
15630
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010015631thread : integer
15632 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
15633 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
15634 and debugging purposes.
15635
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015636var(<var-name>) : undefined
15637 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015638 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
15639 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015640 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015641 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15642 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015643 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015644 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15645 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015646 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015647 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015648
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200156497.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015650----------------------------------
15651
15652The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
15653closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
15654methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
15655sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
15656TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015657the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
15658counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020015659"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
15660used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
15661can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
15662Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
15663table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
15664tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
15665currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015666
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010015667bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010015668 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15669 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15670 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
15671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015672be_id : integer
15673 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020015674 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
15675 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015676
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015677be_name : string
15678 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020015679 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
15680 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015681
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015682dst : ip
15683 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
15684 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
15685 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
15686 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015687 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
15688 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
15689 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
15690 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
15691 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
15692 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015693
15694dst_conn : integer
15695 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15696 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
15697 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
15698 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
15699 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
15700 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
15701 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
15702 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015703
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015704dst_is_local : boolean
15705 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
15706 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
15707 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
15708 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015709 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015710 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
15711 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
15712 it only once per connection.
15713
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015714dst_port : integer
15715 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
15716 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
15717 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
15718 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
15719 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
15720 an HTTP header.
15721
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020015722fc_http_major : integer
15723 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15724 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15725 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
15726
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020015727fc_pp_authority : string
15728 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
15729 if any.
15730
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010015731fc_pp_unique_id : string
15732 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
15733 if any.
15734
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010015735fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
15736 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
15737 header.
15738
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020015739fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
15740 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
15741 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
15742 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
15743 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15744 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15745 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15746
15747fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
15748 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
15749 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
15750 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
15751 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15752 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15753 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15754
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015755fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015756 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15757 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15758 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15759 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15760
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015761fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015762 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15763 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15764 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15765 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15766
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015767fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015768 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
15769 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15770 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15771 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15772
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015773fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015774 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
15775 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15776 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15777 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15778
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015779fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015780 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
15781 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15782 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15783 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15784
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015785fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015786 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
15787 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15788 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15789 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15790
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020015791fe_defbe : string
15792 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
15793 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
15794
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015795fe_id : integer
15796 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010015797 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015798 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15799
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015800fe_name : string
15801 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
15802 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
15803 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15804
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015805sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015806sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15807sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15808sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015809 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
15810 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15811 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
15812
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015813sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015814sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15815sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15816sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015817 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
15818 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15819 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
15820
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015821sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015822sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15823sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15824sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015825 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15826 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015827 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15828 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15829 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015830
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015831 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015832 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15833 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015834 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15835 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
15836 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015837 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15838 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15839
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015840sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15841sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15842sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15843sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15844 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15845 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
15846 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15847 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15848 when a first ACL was verified.
15849
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015850sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015851sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15852sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15853sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015854 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015855 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
15856
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015857sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015858sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15859sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15860sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015861 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15862 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
15863 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
15864
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015865sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015866sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15867sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15868sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015869 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
15870 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
15871 See also src_conn_rate.
15872
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015873sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015874sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15875sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15876sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015877 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015878 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015879
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015880sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15881sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15882sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15883sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15884 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15885 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15886
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015887sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15888sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15889sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15890sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15891 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15892 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
15893
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015894sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015895sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15896sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15897sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015898 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
15899 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15900 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015901 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15902 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15903 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015904
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015905sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15906sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15907sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15908sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15909 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15910 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15911 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15912 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15913 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15914 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15915
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015916sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015917sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15918sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15919sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015920 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015921 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
15922 See also src_http_err_cnt.
15923
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015924sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015925sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15926sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15927sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015928 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
15929 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15930 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
15931 src_http_err_rate.
15932
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015933sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015934sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15935sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15936sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015937 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015938 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15939 src_http_req_cnt.
15940
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015941sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015942sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15943sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15944sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015945 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
15946 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
15947 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15948 src_http_req_rate.
15949
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015950sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015951sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15952sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15953sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015954 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015955 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15956 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15957 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15958 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015959
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015960 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015961 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15962 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015963 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15964
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015965sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15966sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15967sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15968sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15969 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
15970 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15971 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15972 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15973 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
15974
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015975sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015976sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15977sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15978sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015979 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
15980 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15981 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015982
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015983sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015984sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15985sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15986sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015987 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
15988 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15989 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015990
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015991sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015992sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15993sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15994sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015995 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015996 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
15997 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
15998 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015999 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016000 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
16001
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016002sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016003sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16004sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16005sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016006 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
16007 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
16008 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
16009 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
16010 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016011 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016012
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016013sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016014sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
16015sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
16016sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020016017 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
16018 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
16019 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
16020
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016021sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016022sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
16023sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
16024sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016025 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
16026 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016027 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016028 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
16029 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016030 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
16031 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
16032 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016034so_id : integer
16035 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
16036 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
16037 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016038
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010016039so_name : string
16040 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
16041 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
16042 strings instead of integers.
16043
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016044src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016045 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016046 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
16047 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
16048 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016049 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
16050 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
16051 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010016052 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
16053 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
16054 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
16055 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
16056 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
16057 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
16058 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016059
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016060 Example:
16061 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
16062 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
16063
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016064src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16065 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
16066 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
16067 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016068 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016070src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16071 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
16072 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016073 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016074 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016075
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016076src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16077 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16078 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16079 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
16080 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
16081 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
16082 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016083
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016084 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016085 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
16086 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
16087 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
16088 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016089 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016090 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
16091 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16092
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016093src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16094 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16095 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16096 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
16097 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
16098 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
16099 was verified.
16100
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016101src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016102 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016103 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016104 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016105 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016106
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016107src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016108 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016109 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
16110 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016111 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016112
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016113src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16114 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
16115 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16116 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016117 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016118
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016119src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016120 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016121 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016122 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016123 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016124
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016125src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16126 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
16127 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
16128 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
16129 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
16130
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016131src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16132 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
16133 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
16134 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
16135 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
16136
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016137src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016138 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016139 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016140 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
16141 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016142 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
16143 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16144 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016145
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016146src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16147 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
16148 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
16149 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
16150 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
16151 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
16152 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16153 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
16154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016155src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016156 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016157 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016158 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016159 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016160 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016161
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016162src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16163 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
16164 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16165 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
16166 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016167 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016168
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016169src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016170 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016171 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
16172 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016173 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016174
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016175src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16176 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
16177 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
16178 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016179 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016180 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016181
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016182src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16183 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16184 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16185 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016186 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016187 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
16188 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016189
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016190 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016191 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016192 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016193 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016194
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016195src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16196 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16197 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16198 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
16199 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
16200 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
16201 connection when a first ACL was verified.
16202
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016203src_is_local : boolean
16204 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
16205 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
16206 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
16207 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016208 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016209 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
16210 once per connection.
16211
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016212src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016213 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
16214 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
16215 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
16216 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
16217 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016218
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016219src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016220 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
16221 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16222 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
16223 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
16224 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016225
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016226src_port : integer
16227 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
16228 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
16229 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
16230 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016231
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016232src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016233 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016234 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16235 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
16236 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016237 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016238
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016239src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16240 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
16241 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16242 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
16243 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016244 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016245
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016246src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16247 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
16248 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
16249 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
16250 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
16251 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
16252 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
16253 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
16254 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016255
16256 Example :
16257 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
16258 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
16259 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
16260 listen ssh
16261 bind :22
16262 mode tcp
16263 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016264 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016265 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016266 server local 127.0.0.1:22
16267
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016268srv_id : integer
16269 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
16270 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016271 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020016272
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080016273srv_name : string
16274 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
16275 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016276 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080016277
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200162787.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016279----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020016280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016281The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
16282closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
16283when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
16284usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016285future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020016286
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001628751d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
16288 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16289 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16290 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
16291 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16292 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16293
16294 Example :
16295 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
16296 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
16297 # the request.
16298 frontend http-in
16299 bind *:8081
16300 default_backend servers
16301 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16302 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16303
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016304ssl_bc : boolean
16305 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
16306 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016307 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
16308 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016309
16310ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
16311 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016312 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
16313 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016314
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016315ssl_bc_alpn : string
16316 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
16317 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020016318 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016319 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
16320 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
16321 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
16322 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
16323 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016324 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
16325 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016326
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016327ssl_bc_cipher : string
16328 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016329 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
16330 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016331
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016332ssl_bc_client_random : binary
16333 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
16334 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16335 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016336 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016337
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010016338ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
16339 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16340 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016341 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
16342 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010016343
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016344ssl_bc_npn : string
16345 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
16346 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020016347 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016348 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
16349 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
16350 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
16351 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016352 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
16353 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016354
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016355ssl_bc_protocol : string
16356 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016357 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
16358 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016359
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016360ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016361 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016362 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016363 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
16364 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016365
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016366ssl_bc_server_random : binary
16367 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
16368 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16369 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016370 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016371
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016372ssl_bc_session_id : binary
16373 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
16374 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016375 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
16376 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016377
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016378ssl_bc_session_key : binary
16379 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
16380 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
16381 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016382 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016383
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016384ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
16385 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016386 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
16387 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016388
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016389ssl_c_ca_err : integer
16390 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16391 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
16392 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
16393 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
16394 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020016395
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016396ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
16397 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16398 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
16399 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
16400 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016401
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010016402ssl_c_der : binary
16403 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
16404 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16405 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
16406
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016407ssl_c_err : integer
16408 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16409 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
16410 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
16411 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
16412 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016413
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016414ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016415 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16416 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
16417 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16418 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16419 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16420 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16421 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16422 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016423 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16424 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16425 LDAP v3.
16426 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16427 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016428
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016429ssl_c_key_alg : string
16430 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
16431 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16432 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016433
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016434ssl_c_notafter : string
16435 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
16436 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16437 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016438
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016439ssl_c_notbefore : string
16440 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
16441 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16442 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010016443
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016444ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016445 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16446 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
16447 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16448 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16449 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16450 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16451 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16452 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016453 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16454 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16455 LDAP v3.
16456 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16457 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010016458
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016459ssl_c_serial : binary
16460 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
16461 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16462 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016463
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016464ssl_c_sha1 : binary
16465 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
16466 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
16467 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020016468 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
16469 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
16470
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016471 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020016472 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016473
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016474ssl_c_sig_alg : string
16475 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
16476 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16477 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016478
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016479ssl_c_used : boolean
16480 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
16481 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016483ssl_c_verify : integer
16484 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
16485 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
16486 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
16487 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016489ssl_c_version : integer
16490 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
16491 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016492
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010016493ssl_f_der : binary
16494 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
16495 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16496 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
16497
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016498ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016499 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16500 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
16501 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16502 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016503 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016504 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16505 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16506 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016507 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16508 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16509 LDAP v3.
16510 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16511 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016512
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016513ssl_f_key_alg : string
16514 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
16515 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
16516 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016517
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016518ssl_f_notafter : string
16519 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
16520 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16521 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016522
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016523ssl_f_notbefore : string
16524 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
16525 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16526 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016527
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016528ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016529 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16530 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
16531 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16532 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16533 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16534 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16535 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16536 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016537 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16538 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16539 LDAP v3.
16540 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16541 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016542
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016543ssl_f_serial : binary
16544 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
16545 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16546 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016547
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020016548ssl_f_sha1 : binary
16549 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
16550 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
16551 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
16552
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016553ssl_f_sig_alg : string
16554 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
16555 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16556 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016557
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016558ssl_f_version : integer
16559 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
16560 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16561
16562ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016563 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
16564 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
16565 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
16566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016567 Example :
16568 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
16569 listen http-https
16570 bind :80
16571 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
16572 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
16573
16574ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
16575 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
16576 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16577
16578ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016579 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016580 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
16581 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
16582 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
16583 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
16584 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
16585 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
16586 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
16587 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
16588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016589ssl_fc_cipher : string
16590 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
16591 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020016592
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016593ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
16594 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
16595 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016596 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016597
16598ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
16599 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
16600 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016601 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016602
16603ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
16604 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
16605 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
16606 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016607 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020016608 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016609
16610ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
16611 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
16612 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016613 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016614
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016615ssl_fc_client_random : binary
16616 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
16617 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16618 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16619
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016620ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016621 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
16622 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010016623 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
16624 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
16625 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
16626 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016627
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020016628ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
16629 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
16630 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
16631 wait until the handshake happened.
16632
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016633ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
16634 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020016635 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
16636 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016637 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020016638 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016639
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020016640ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020016641 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010016642 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
16643 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020016644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016645ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016646 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016647 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
16648 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
16649 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
16650 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
16651 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
16652 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
16653 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020016654
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016655ssl_fc_protocol : string
16656 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
16657 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016658
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016659ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016660 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016661 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
16662 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016663
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016664ssl_fc_server_random : binary
16665 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
16666 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16667 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16668
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016669ssl_fc_session_id : binary
16670 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
16671 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
16672 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
16673 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016674
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016675ssl_fc_session_key : binary
16676 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
16677 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
16678 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
16679 BoringSSL.
16680
16681
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016682ssl_fc_sni : string
16683 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
16684 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
16685 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
16686 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
16687 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
16688
16689 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
16690 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
16691 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016692 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020016693 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016694
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016695 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016696 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
16697 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020016698
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016699ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
16700 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
16701 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016702
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016703
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200167047.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016705------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016706
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016707Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
16708sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
16709only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
16710For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
16711be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
16712can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
16713sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
16714for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
16715content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016717payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016718 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016719 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
16720 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016721
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016722payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
16723 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016724 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016725 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016726
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020016727req.hdrs : string
16728 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
16729 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
16730 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
16731 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
16732
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020016733req.hdrs_bin : binary
16734 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
16735 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
16736 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
16737 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
16738 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
16739 names and values (length of 0 for both).
16740
16741 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
16742
16743 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
16744 str: <int:length><bytes>
16745
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016746req.len : integer
16747req_len : integer (deprecated)
16748 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16749 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16750 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16751 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16752 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16753 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16754 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
16755 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016756
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016757req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16758 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016759 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16760 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16761 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16762 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016763
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016764 ACL alternatives :
16765 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016767req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16768 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16769 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16770 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
16771 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016772
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016773 ACL alternatives :
16774 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016775
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016776 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016777
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016778req.proto_http : boolean
16779req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
16780 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
16781 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
16782 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
16783 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
16784 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
16785 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
16786 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016788 Example:
16789 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
16790 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16791 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016792 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016793
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016794req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
16795rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16796 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
16797 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
16798 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
16799 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
16800 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
16801 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
16802 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016803
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016804 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
16805 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
16806 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
16807 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
16808 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
16809 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016810
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016811 ACL derivatives :
16812 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016813
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016814 Example :
16815 listen tse-farm
16816 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
16817 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
16818 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16819 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
16820 # apply RDP cookie persistence
16821 persist rdp-cookie
16822 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
16823 # This is only useful makes sense if
16824 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
16825 stick-table type string size 204800
16826 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
16827 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
16828 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016830 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
16831 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016832
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016833req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
16834rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
16835 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
16836 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
16837 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
16838 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016840 ACL derivatives :
16841 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016842
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016843req.ssl_alpn : string
16844 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
16845 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
16846 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
16847 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
16848 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
16849 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016850 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016851
16852 Examples :
16853 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16854 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16855 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016856 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016857 default_backend bk_default
16858
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016859req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
16860 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
16861 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016862 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
16863 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
16864 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
16865 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
16866 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016867
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016868req.ssl_hello_type : integer
16869req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16870 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16871 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
16872 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16873 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16874 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
16875 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16876 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016877
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016878req.ssl_sni : string
16879req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
16880 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
16881 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
16882 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
16883 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16884 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16885 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
16886 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
16887 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
16888 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
16889 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
16890 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
16891 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016892
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016893 ACL derivatives :
16894 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016895
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016896 Examples :
16897 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16898 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16899 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
16900 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
16901 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016902
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053016903req.ssl_st_ext : integer
16904 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
16905 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
16906 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
16907 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
16908 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
16909 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
16910 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
16911 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
16912 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
16913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016914req.ssl_ver : integer
16915req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
16916 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
16917 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
16918 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
16919 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
16920 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16921 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16922 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016923 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016924 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016925
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016926 ACL derivatives :
16927 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016928
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020016929res.len : integer
16930 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16931 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16932 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16933 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16934 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16935 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16936 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
16937 content inspection.
16938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016939res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16940 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016941 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16942 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16943 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16944 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016946res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16947 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16948 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16949 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
16950 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016951
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016952 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016953
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020016954res.ssl_hello_type : integer
16955rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16956 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16957 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
16958 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16959 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16960 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
16961 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16962 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
16963
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016964wait_end : boolean
16965 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
16966 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016967 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016968 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
16969 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016970 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016971 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
16972 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016974 Examples :
16975 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
16976 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
16977 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016978
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016979 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
16980 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16981 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
16982 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
16983 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
16984 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
16985 tcp-request content reject
16986
16987
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200169887.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016989--------------------------------------
16990
16991It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
16992This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
16993data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
16994its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
16995HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
16996content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
16997to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
16998more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
16999response are indexed.
17000
17001base : string
17002 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
17003 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
17004 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
17005 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
17006 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
17007 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
17008 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
17009 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
17010
17011 ACL derivatives :
17012 base : exact string match
17013 base_beg : prefix match
17014 base_dir : subdir match
17015 base_dom : domain match
17016 base_end : suffix match
17017 base_len : length match
17018 base_reg : regex match
17019 base_sub : substring match
17020
17021base32 : integer
17022 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
17023 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
17024 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017025 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
17026 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
17027 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017028
17029base32+src : binary
17030 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
17031 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
17032 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
17033 per-URL counters.
17034
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010017035capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
17036 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
17037 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
17038 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
17039
17040capture.req.method : string
17041 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
17042 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
17043 because it's allocated.
17044
17045capture.req.uri : string
17046 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
17047 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
17048 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
17049 allocated.
17050
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020017051capture.req.ver : string
17052 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
17053 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
17054 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
17055
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010017056capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
17057 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
17058 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
17059 The first entry is an index of 0.
17060 See also: "capture response header"
17061
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020017062capture.res.ver : string
17063 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
17064 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
17065 persistent flag.
17066
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017067req.body : binary
17068 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
17069 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
17070 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
17071 the first chunk is analyzed.
17072
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020017073req.body_param([<name>) : string
17074 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
17075 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
17076 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
17077 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
17078 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
17079 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
17080 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
17081 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
17082 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
17083 given.
17084
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017085req.body_len : integer
17086 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
17087 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
17088 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
17089 "option http-buffer-request".
17090
17091req.body_size : integer
17092 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
17093 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
17094 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
17095 that the request body has been buffered made available using
17096 "option http-buffer-request".
17097
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017098req.cook([<name>]) : string
17099cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17100 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17101 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
17102 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
17103 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
17104 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
17105 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
17106 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
17107 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
17108
17109 ACL derivatives :
17110 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
17111 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
17112 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
17113 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
17114 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
17115 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
17116 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
17117 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017118
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017119req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17120cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17121 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
17122 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017123
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017124req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
17125cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17126 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17127 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
17128 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
17129 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020017130
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017131cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17132 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17133 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
17134 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
17135 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020017136 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017137 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
17138 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
17139 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
17140 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017141
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017142hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17143 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
17144 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
17145 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
17146 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017147 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017148
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017149req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
17150 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
17151 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
17152 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17153 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17154 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17155 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
17156 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
17157 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017158
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017159req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17160 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
17161 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17162 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
17163 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017164
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017165req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17166 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
17167 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
17168 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17169 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17170 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17171 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
17172 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
17173 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000017174 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017175 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017176 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017177
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017178 ACL derivatives :
17179 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
17180 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
17181 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
17182 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
17183 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
17184 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
17185 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
17186 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
17187
17188req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17189hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
17190 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
17191 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
17192 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
17193 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
17194 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
17195 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
17196 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
17197 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
17198 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
17199
17200req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
17201hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
17202 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
17203 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
17204 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
17205 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
17206 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017207 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017208 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
17209 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
17210
17211req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
17212hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
17213 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
17214 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
17215 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
17216 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17217 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17218 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17219 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
17220
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010017221
17222
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017223http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
17224 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
17225 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
17226 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
17227 basic auth is supported.
17228
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010017229http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
17230 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
17231 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
17232 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
17233 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017234 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
17235 basic auth is supported.
17236
17237 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010017238 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
17239 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
17240 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
17241 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017242
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017243http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010017244 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
17245 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
17246 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017247
17248http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010017249 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
17250 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
17251 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017252
17253http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010017254 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
17255 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
17256 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017258http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020017259 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
17260 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017261 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
17262 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020017263
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017264method : integer + string
17265 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
17266 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
17267 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
17268 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
17269 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
17270 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
17271 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017272
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017273 ACL derivatives :
17274 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017275
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017276 Example :
17277 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
17278 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
17279 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017281path : string
17282 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
17283 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
17284 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
17285 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
17286 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017287 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017288 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017290 ACL derivatives :
17291 path : exact string match
17292 path_beg : prefix match
17293 path_dir : subdir match
17294 path_dom : domain match
17295 path_end : suffix match
17296 path_len : length match
17297 path_reg : regex match
17298 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017299
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010017300query : string
17301 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
17302 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
17303 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
17304 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017305 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010017306 which stops before the question mark.
17307
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010017308req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
17309 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
17310 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
17311 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
17312 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
17313
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017314req.ver : string
17315req_ver : string (deprecated)
17316 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
17317 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
17318 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017319
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017320 ACL derivatives :
17321 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020017322
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017323res.comp : boolean
17324 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
17325 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
17326 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017327
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017328res.comp_algo : string
17329 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
17330 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
17331 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017332
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017333res.cook([<name>]) : string
17334scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17335 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
17336 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
17337 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020017338
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017339 ACL derivatives :
17340 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020017341
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017342res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17343scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17344 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
17345 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
17346 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017347
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017348res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
17349scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17350 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
17351 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
17352 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017353
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017354res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17355 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
17356 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
17357 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
17358 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
17359 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
17360 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
17361 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
17362 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
17363 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017364
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017365res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17366 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
17367 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17368 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
17369 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
17370 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017371
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017372res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17373shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
17374 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
17375 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
17376 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
17377 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
17378 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
17379 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
17380 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
17381 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017382
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017383 ACL derivatives :
17384 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
17385 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
17386 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
17387 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
17388 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
17389 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
17390 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
17391 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
17392
17393res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17394shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17395 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
17396 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17397 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
17398 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
17399 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017400
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017401res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
17402shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
17403 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
17404 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
17405 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
17406 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
17407 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
17408 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017409
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010017410res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
17411 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
17412 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
17413 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
17414 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
17415
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017416res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
17417shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
17418 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
17419 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
17420 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
17421 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
17422 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
17423 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010017424
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017425res.ver : string
17426resp_ver : string (deprecated)
17427 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
17428 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020017429
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017430 ACL derivatives :
17431 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010017432
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017433set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17434 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
17435 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020017436 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017437 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010017438
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017439 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
17440 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010017441
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017442status : integer
17443 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
17444 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
17445 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017446
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020017447unique-id : string
17448 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
17449 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
17450 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
17451 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
17452 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
17453 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
17454
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017455url : string
17456 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
17457 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
17458 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
17459 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
17460 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
17461 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
17462 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017463
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017464 ACL derivatives :
17465 url : exact string match
17466 url_beg : prefix match
17467 url_dir : subdir match
17468 url_dom : domain match
17469 url_end : suffix match
17470 url_len : length match
17471 url_reg : regex match
17472 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017473
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017474url_ip : ip
17475 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
17476 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
17477 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
17478 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
17479 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
17480 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
17481 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017483url_port : integer
17484 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
17485 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
17486 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
17487 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017488
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020017489urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
17490url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017491 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
17492 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020017493 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
17494 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
17495 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
17496 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017497 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
17498 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020017499 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
17500 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017501
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017502 ACL derivatives :
17503 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
17504 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
17505 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
17506 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
17507 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
17508 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
17509 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
17510 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017511
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017512
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017513 Example :
17514 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
17515 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
17516 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
17517 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017518
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017519urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017520 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
17521 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
17522 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020017523
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020017524url32 : integer
17525 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
17526 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
17527 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
17528 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
17529 is an unsigned integer.
17530
17531url32+src : binary
17532 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
17533 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
17534 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
17535
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010017536
Christopher Fauletba3c68f2020-04-01 16:27:05 +0200175377.3.7. Fetching health-check samples
17538-------------------------------------
17539
17540This set of sample fetch methods may be called from an health-check execution
17541context. It was introduced in the version 2.2. The following sample fetches are
17542placed in the dedicated scope "check". Other sample fetches may also be called
17543when an health-check is performed if it makes sense and if the sample fetch was
17544adapted to be called in this context.
17545
Christopher Faulet78f371e2020-04-30 09:38:08 +020017546check.len : integer
17547 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
17548 check input buffer, containing the data received from the server. This can be
17549 called from a tcp-check expect rule, or eventually from a set-var rule after
17550 an expect rule and before a send rule (check input buffer is filled on
17551 tcp-check expect rules and reset on tcp-check send rules).
17552
Christopher Fauletba3c68f2020-04-01 16:27:05 +020017553check.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
17554 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Christopher Faulet78f371e2020-04-30 09:38:08 +020017555 in the check input buffer, containing data received from the server. As a
17556 special case, if the <length> argument is zero, then the whole buffer from
17557 <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be called from a tcp-check expect
17558 rule, or eventually from a set-var rule after an expect rule and before a
17559 send rule (check input buffer is filled on tcp-check expect rules and reset
17560 on tcp-check send rules).
Christopher Fauletba3c68f2020-04-01 16:27:05 +020017561
Christopher Faulet78f371e2020-04-30 09:38:08 +020017562check.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
17563 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for
17564 <length> bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the
17565 length in the check input buffer, containing data received from the
17566 server. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if prepended
17567 with a '+' or '-' sign. This can be called from a tcp-check expect rule, or
17568 eventually from a set-var rule after an expect rule and before a send rule
17569 (check input buffer is filled on tcp-check expect rules and reset on
17570 tcp-check send rules).
Christopher Fauletba3c68f2020-04-01 16:27:05 +020017571
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020017572check.body : binary
17573 Returns the available body of the HTTP response in the context of a
17574 http-check health check as a block of data.
17575
17576check.body_param([<name>) : string
17577 Assumes the body of the HTTP response in the context of a http-check health
17578 check is url-encoded. This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter
17579 <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
17580 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
17581 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of
17582 the parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
17583 performed).
17584
17585check.body_len : integer
17586 Returns the length in bytes of the available body of the HTTP response in the
17587 context of a http-check health check. It may be lower than the advertised
17588 length if the body is larger than the buffer.
17589
17590check.body_size : integer
17591 Returns the advertised length of the HTTP response's body in bytes in the
17592 context of a http-check health check. It will represent the advertised
17593 Content-Length header, or the size of the available body in case of chunked
17594 encoding.
17595
17596check.cook([<name>]) : string
17597 Extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
17598 header line from the HTTP response in the context of a http-check health
17599 check, and returns its value as string. If no name is specified, the first
17600 cookie value is returned.
17601
17602check.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17603 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
17604 <name> in the HTTP response in the context of a http-check health check, or
17605 all cookies if <name> is not specified.
17606
17607check.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
17608 Extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
17609 header line from the HTTP response in the context of a http-check health
17610 check, and converts its value to an integer which is returned. If no name is
17611 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
17612
17613check.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
17614 Extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response in the
17615 context of a http-check health check. Optionally, a specific occurrence might
17616 be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from
17617 the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
17618 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It differs
17619 from check.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned and are
17620 not used as delimiters.
17621
17622check.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17623 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
17624 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17625 not specified, in the context of a http-check health check. Contrary to its
17626 check.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns the number of full line headers
17627 and does not stop on commas.
17628
17629check.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17630
17631 Extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response in the
17632 context of a http-check health check. Optionally, a specific occurrence might
17633 be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from
17634 the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
17635 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
17636 is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP, associated with an
17637 IP stick-table. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
17638 values. If full-line headers are desired instead, use check.fhdr(). Please
17639 carefully check RFC7231 to know how certain headers are supposed to be
17640 parsed. Also, some of them are case insensitive (e.g. Connection).
17641
17642check.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17643 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
17644 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
17645 <name> is not specified, in the context of a http-check health check. It is
17646 important to remember that one header line may count as several headers if it
17647 has several values. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for
17648 distinct values. If full-line headers are desired instead, check.fhdr_cnt()
17649 should be used instead. See "check.hdr" for more information on header
17650 matching.
17651
17652check.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
17653 Extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response in the
17654 context of a http-check health check, converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address
17655 and returns this address. If <name> is omitted, every value of every header
17656 is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a
17657 position number. Positive values indicate a position from the first
17658 occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate positions
17659 relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with
17660 the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
17661
17662check.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
17663 Extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response in the
17664 context of a http-check health check, and converts it to an integer value. If
17665 <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked. Optionally, a
17666 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
17667 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first
17668 one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1
17669 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
17670
17671check.hdrs : string
17672 Returns the headers in the HTTP response in the context of a http-check
17673 health check as string including the last empty line separating headers from
17674 the response body. The last empty line can be used to detect a truncated
17675 header block.
17676
17677check.hdrs_bin : binary
17678 Returns the headers in the HTTP response in the context of a http-check
17679 health check in preparsed binary form.
17680
17681check.status : integer
17682 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code of the HTTP response in
17683 the context of a http-check health check, for example, 302.
17684
17685check.ver : string (deprecated)
17686 Returns the version string from the HTTP response in the context of a
17687 http-check health check, for example "1.1".
17688
17689
Christopher Fauletba3c68f2020-04-01 16:27:05 +0200176907.3.8. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017691---------------------------------------
17692
17693This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
17694used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
17695purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
17696There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
17697or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
17698any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
17699for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
17700
17701internal.htx.data : integer
17702 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
17703 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17704
17705internal.htx.free : integer
17706 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
17707 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17708
17709internal.htx.free_data : integer
17710 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
17711 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17712
17713internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
17714 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
17715 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
17716 chosen depending on the sample direction.
17717
17718internal.htx.nbblks : integer
17719 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
17720 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17721
17722internal.htx.size : integer
17723 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
17724 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17725
17726internal.htx.used : integer
17727 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
17728 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17729 direction.
17730
17731internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
17732 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
17733 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
17734 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
17735 of the special value :
17736 * head : The oldest inserted block
17737 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017738 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017739
17740internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
17741 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
17742 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
17743 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
17744 integer or one of the special value :
17745 * head : The oldest inserted block
17746 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017747 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017748
17749internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
17750 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
17751 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
17752 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17753 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17754
17755 * head : The oldest inserted block
17756 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017757 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017758
17759internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
17760 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
17761 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
17762 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17763 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17764
17765 * head : The oldest inserted block
17766 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017767 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017768
17769internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
17770 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
17771 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
17772 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17773 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17774
17775 * head : The oldest inserted block
17776 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017777 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017778
17779internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
17780 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
17781 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
17782 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17783 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17784
17785 * head : The oldest inserted block
17786 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017787 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017788
17789internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
17790 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
17791 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
17792 it returns false.
17793
17794
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200177957.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017796---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017797
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017798Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
17799every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020017800order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017801
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017802ACL name Equivalent to Usage
17803---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017804FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020017805HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017806HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
17807HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017808HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
17809HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
17810HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
17811HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
17812LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017813METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020017814METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017815METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
17816METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
17817METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
17818METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020017819METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017820METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020017821RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017822REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017823TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017824WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
17825---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017826
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010017827
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178288. Logging
17829----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010017830
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017831One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
17832provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
17833very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
17834provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
17835state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017836to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017837headers.
17838
17839In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
17840about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
17841send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
17842
17843 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
17844 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
17845 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
17846 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
17847 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017848 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060017849 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017850
17851The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
17852allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
17853as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
17854while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
17855real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
17856delay.
17857
17858
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178598.1. Log levels
17860---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017861
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017862TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017863source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017864HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
17865in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
17866track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
17867syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
17868about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017869
17870
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178718.2. Log formats
17872----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017873
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017874HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017875and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
17876slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
17877options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017878
17879 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
17880 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
17881 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
17882 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
17883 extents.
17884
17885 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
17886 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
17887 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
17888 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
17889 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
17890
17891 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
17892 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
17893 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
17894 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
17895 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
17896
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020017897 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
17898 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
17899 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
17900 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
17901
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017902 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
17903
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017904Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
17905specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
17906field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
17907servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
17908always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
17909identifier.
17910
17911Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
17912 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
17913 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
17914 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
17915 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
17916
17917
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179188.2.1. Default log format
17919-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017920
17921This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
17922as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
17923format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
17924
17925 Example :
17926 listen www
17927 mode http
17928 log global
17929 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17930
17931 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
17932 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
17933 (www/HTTP)
17934
17935 Field Format Extract from the example above
17936 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
17937 2 'Connect from' Connect from
17938 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
17939 4 'to' to
17940 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
17941 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
17942
17943Detailed fields description :
17944 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
17945 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
17946 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
17947 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
17948 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17949 and processed the connection.
17950 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
17951
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017952In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
17953"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
17954connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
17955
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017956It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
17957will eventually disappear.
17958
17959
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179608.2.2. TCP log format
17961---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017962
17963The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
17964is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
17965information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
17966counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
17967emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
17968environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
17969the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
17970sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017971specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
17972not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
17973fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
17974marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017975
17976 Example :
17977 frontend fnt
17978 mode tcp
17979 option tcplog
17980 log global
17981 default_backend bck
17982
17983 backend bck
17984 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17985
17986 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
17987 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
17988 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
17989
17990 Field Format Extract from the example above
17991 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
17992 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
17993 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
17994 4 frontend_name fnt
17995 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
17996 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
17997 7 bytes_read* 212
17998 8 termination_state --
17999 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
18000 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
18001
18002Detailed fields description :
18003 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018004 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
18005 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
18006 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018007 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018008 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018009 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018010
18011 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018012 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
18013 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
18014 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018015
18016 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
18017 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
18018 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018019 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
18020 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
18021 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
18022 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018023
18024 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18025 and processed the connection.
18026
18027 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
18028 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
18029 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
18030 applications.
18031
18032 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
18033 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
18034 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
18035 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
18036 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
18037
18038 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
18039 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
18040 See "Timers" below for more details.
18041
18042 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
18043 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
18044 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
18045 "Timers" below for more details.
18046
18047 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018048 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018049 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
18050 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
18051 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
18052 details.
18053
18054 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
18055 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
18056 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
18057 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
18058 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
18059
18060 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
18061 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
18062 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
18063 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
18064 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
18065 for more details.
18066
18067 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018068 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018069 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
18070 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
18071 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018072 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018073
18074 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
18075 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
18076 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
18077 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
18078 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
18079 caused by a denial of service attack.
18080
18081 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
18082 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
18083 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
18084 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
18085 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
18086 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
18087 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
18088 denial of service attack.
18089
18090 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
18091 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
18092 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
18093 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
18094 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
18095 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
18096 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
18097 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
18098 be processed than on other servers.
18099
18100 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
18101 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
18102 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
18103 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
18104 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
18105 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
18106 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
18107 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
18108 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
18109 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
18110 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
18111 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
18112 should not be attributed to the logged server.
18113
18114 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18115 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
18116 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
18117 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
18118 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
18119 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018120 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018121 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
18122
18123 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18124 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
18125 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
18126 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
18127 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
18128 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018129 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018130 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
18131 occurs.
18132
18133
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200181348.2.3. HTTP log format
18135----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018136
18137The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
18138is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
18139the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
18140are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
18141emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
18142generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
18143"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
18144which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018145frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
18146is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018147
18148Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
18149slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
18150with a star ('*') after the field name below.
18151
18152 Example :
18153 frontend http-in
18154 mode http
18155 option httplog
18156 log global
18157 default_backend bck
18158
18159 backend static
18160 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18161
18162 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
18163 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
18164 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018165 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018166
18167 Field Format Extract from the example above
18168 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
18169 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018170 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018171 4 frontend_name http-in
18172 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018173 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018174 7 status_code 200
18175 8 bytes_read* 2750
18176 9 captured_request_cookie -
18177 10 captured_response_cookie -
18178 11 termination_state ----
18179 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
18180 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
18181 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
18182 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
18183 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018184
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018185Detailed fields description :
18186 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018187 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
18188 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
18189 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018190 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018191 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018192 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018193
18194 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018195 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
18196 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
18197 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018198
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018199 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
18200 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018201
18202 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18203 and processed the connection.
18204
18205 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
18206 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
18207 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
18208
18209 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
18210 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
18211 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
18212 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
18213 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
18214 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
18215
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018216 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
18217 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
18218 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018219 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018220 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
18221 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018222 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
18223 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018224
18225 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
18226 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018227 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018228
18229 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
18230 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018231 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
18232 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018233
18234 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
18235 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
18236 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
18237 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
18238 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018239 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
18240 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018241
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018242 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
18243 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
18244 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
18245 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
18246 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
18247 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
18248 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018249 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018250
18251 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
18252 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
18253 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
18254
18255 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
18256 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018257 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018258 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
18259 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
18260 overflowing.
18261
18262 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
18263 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
18264 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
18265 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
18266 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
18267 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
18268 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
18269 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
18270
18271 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
18272 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
18273 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
18274 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
18275 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
18276 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
18277 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
18278 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
18279
18280 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
18281 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
18282 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
18283 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
18284 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
18285 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
18286 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
18287
18288 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018289 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018290 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
18291 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
18292 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018293 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018294 system.
18295
18296 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
18297 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
18298 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
18299 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
18300 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
18301 caused by a denial of service attack.
18302
18303 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
18304 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
18305 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
18306 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
18307 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
18308 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
18309 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
18310 denial of service attack.
18311
18312 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
18313 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
18314 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
18315 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
18316 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
18317 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
18318 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
18319 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
18320 processed than on other servers.
18321
18322 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
18323 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
18324 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
18325 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
18326 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
18327 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
18328 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
18329 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
18330 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
18331 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
18332 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
18333 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
18334 should not be attributed to the logged server.
18335
18336 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18337 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
18338 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
18339 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
18340 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
18341 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018342 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018343 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
18344
18345 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18346 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
18347 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
18348 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
18349 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
18350 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018351 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018352 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
18353 occurs.
18354
18355 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
18356 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
18357 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
18358 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
18359 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
18360 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
18361 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
18362 cookies" below for more details.
18363
18364 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
18365 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
18366 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
18367 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
18368 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
18369 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
18370 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
18371 and cookies" below for more details.
18372
18373 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
18374 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
18375 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
18376 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
18377 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
18378 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
18379 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
18380 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
18381
18382
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200183838.2.4. Custom log format
18384------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018385
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018386The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018387mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018388
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018389HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018390Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
18391separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
18392prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
18393
18394Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
18395variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018396("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018397
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010018398If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020018399as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010018400less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
18401the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
18402
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018403Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018404In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010018405in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018406
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018407Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
18408'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
18409https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
18410such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
18411
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018412Flags are :
18413 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018414 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018415 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
18416 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018417
18418 Example:
18419
18420 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
18421 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
18422
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018423 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
18424
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018425At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
18426
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018427 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
18428 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018429
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018430the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018431
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018432 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
18433 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
18434 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018435
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018436and the default TCP format is defined this way :
18437
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018438 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
18439 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018440
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018441Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
18442
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018443 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018444 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018445 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
18446 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
18447 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018448 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
18449 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
18450 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018451 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000018452 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
18453 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000018454 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000018455 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
18456 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010018457 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020018458 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018459 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018460 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018461 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020018462 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080018463 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018464 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
18465 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
18466 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
18467 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
18468 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018469 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018470 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000018471 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018472 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018473 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018474 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
18475 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018476 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
18477 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
18478 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018479 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018480 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
18481 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018482 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018483 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
18484 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
18485 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020018486 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020018487 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020018488 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
18489 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
18490 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
18491 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020018492 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018493 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018494 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018495 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010018496 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018497 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018498 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
18499 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
18500 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018501 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018502 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
18503 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018504 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018505 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
18506 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020018507 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018508 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018509 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018510 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018511
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018512 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018513
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010018514
185158.2.5. Error log format
18516-----------------------
18517
18518When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
18519protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
18520By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
18521"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018522will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010018523logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
18524
18525The format looks like this :
18526
18527 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
18528 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
18529 Connection error during SSL handshake
18530
18531 Field Format Extract from the example above
18532 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
18533 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
18534 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
18535 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
18536 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
18537
18538These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
18539failures.
18540
18541
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185428.3. Advanced logging options
18543-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018544
18545Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
18546just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
18547options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
18548for more information about their usage.
18549
18550
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185518.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
18552------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018553
18554It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
18555haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
18556commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
18557monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
18558ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
18559
18560 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
18561 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
18562 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
18563 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
18564
18565 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
18566 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
18567 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018568 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018569 such as other load-balancers.
18570
18571 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
18572 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
18573 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
18574
18575
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185768.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
18577----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018578
18579The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
18580what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
18581or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018582"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018583just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
18584log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
18585after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
18586is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
18587with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
18588with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
18589
18590
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185918.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
18592------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018593
18594Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
18595for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
18596"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
18597retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
18598raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
18599a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
18600file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
18601you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
18602"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
18603
18604
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200186058.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
18606--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018607
18608Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
18609multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
18610them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
18611"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
18612logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
18613error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
18614and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
18615too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
18616useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
18617alternative.
18618
18619
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200186208.4. Timing events
18621------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018622
18623Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
18624reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
18625the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
18626frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018627mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
18628addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
18629
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010018630Timings events in HTTP mode:
18631
18632 first request 2nd request
18633 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
18634 t tr t tr ...
18635 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
18636 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
18637 :<---- Tq ---->: :
18638 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000018639 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010018640 :<--------- Ta --------->:
18641
18642Timings events in TCP mode:
18643
18644 TCP session
18645 |<----------------->|
18646 t t
18647 ---|----|----|----|----|---
18648 | Th Tw Tc Td |
18649 |<------ Tt ------->|
18650
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018651 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018652 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018653 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
18654 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
18655 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018656 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018657 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
18658 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
18659 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
18660 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018661
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018662 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
18663 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
18664 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018665 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
18666 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
18667 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
18668 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
18669 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
18670 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018671
18672 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
18673 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
18674 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
18675 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
18676 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
18677 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
18678 request typed by hand during a test.
18679
18680 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
18681 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018682 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018683 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
18684 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
18685 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
18686 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018687
18688 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
18689 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
18690 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
18691 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
18692 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
18693
18694 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
18695 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
18696 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
18697 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
18698 connection never established.
18699
18700 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
18701 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
18702 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
18703 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
18704 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
18705 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
18706 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
18707 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
18708 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
18709 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
18710 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
18711
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018712 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
18713 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
18714 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
18715 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
18716 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
18717 by subtracting other timers when valid :
18718
18719 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
18720
18721 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
18722 "Ta" can never be negative.
18723
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018724 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
18725 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018726 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
18727 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018728 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018729
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018730 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018731
18732 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018733 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
18734 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018735
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000018736 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
18737 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
18738 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
18739 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
18740 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
18741 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
18742 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
18743 prefixed with a '+' sign.
18744
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018745These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
18746protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
18747that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018748due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
18749"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
18750that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018751
18752Most common cases :
18753
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018754 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
18755 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
18756 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
18757 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
18758 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
18759 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
18760 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
18761 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
18762 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
18763 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
18764 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020018765 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018766
18767 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
18768 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
18769 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
18770 of ms on remote networks.
18771
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018772 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
18773 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
18774 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018775
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018776 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
18777 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
18778 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
18779 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
18780 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
18781 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
18782 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
18783 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
18784 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018785
18786Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
18787
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018788 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018789 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018790 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018791
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018792 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018793 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
18794 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
18795
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018796 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018797 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
18798 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
18799 flags.
18800
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018801 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
18802 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018803 Check the session termination flags, then check the
18804 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
18805 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
18806 the client connection was maintained open.
18807
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018808 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018809 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018810 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018811 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
18812
18813
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200188148.5. Session state at disconnection
18815-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018816
18817TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
18818"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
188192-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
18820each of which has a special meaning :
18821
18822 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
18823 session to terminate :
18824
18825 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
18826
18827 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
18828 server explicitly refused it.
18829
18830 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
18831 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
18832 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
18833 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018834 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020018835
18836 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
18837 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018838
18839 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
18840 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
18841 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
18842 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
18843 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
18844
18845 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
18846 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
18847 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
18848 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
18849 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
18850
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090018851 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
18852 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
18853
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070018854 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
18855 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
18856 backup connections when going up.
18857
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020018858 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
18859
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018860 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
18861 send or receive data.
18862
18863 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
18864 send or receive data.
18865
18866 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
18867 with nothing left in the buffers.
18868
18869 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
18870
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010018871 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018872 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
18873
18874 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
18875 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
18876 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
18877 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
18878 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
18879
18880 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
18881 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
18882
18883 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
18884 server (HTTP only).
18885
18886 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
18887
18888 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
18889 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
18890 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
18891
18892 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
18893 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
18894 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
18895
18896 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
18897
18898 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
18899 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
18900
18901 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
18902 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
18903 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
18904
18905 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
18906 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020018907 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
18908 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018909
18910 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
18911 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
18912 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
18913 another server.
18914
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018915 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018916 server.
18917
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018918 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
18919 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
18920 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
18921 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
18922
18923 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
18924 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
18925 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
18926 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
18927
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020018928 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
18929 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
18930 "use-server" rule).
18931
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018932 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18933
18934 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
18935 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
18936
18937 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
18938
18939 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
18940 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
18941 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
18942
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018943 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
18944 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018945 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018946 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
18947 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
18948
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018949 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
18950
18951 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
18952 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
18953
18954 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
18955
18956 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18957
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018958The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
18959was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018960helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
18961starvation, attacks, etc...
18962
18963The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
18964alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
18965easier finding and understanding.
18966
18967 Flags Reason
18968
18969 -- Normal termination.
18970
18971 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
18972 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
18973 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
18974 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
18975
18976 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
18977 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
18978 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
18979 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
18980 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
18981 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018982
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018983 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18984 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018985 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018986
18987 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
18988 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
18989 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
18990
18991 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
18992 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
18993 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
18994 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
18995 the server takes too long to respond.
18996
18997 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
18998 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
18999 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
19000 long a time to respond.
19001
19002 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
19003 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
19004 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
19005 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019006 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
19007 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019008
19009 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
19010 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
19011 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
19012 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
19013 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020019014 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019015 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
19016 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
19017 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
19018 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
19019 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
19020 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
19021 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
19022 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019023 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019024 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
19025 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
19026 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019027
19028 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
19029 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019030 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
19031 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
19032 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
19033 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019034
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020019035 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
19036 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
19037
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019038 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019039 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
19040 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019041 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019042 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
19043 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
19044
19045 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
19046 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
19047 503 or 504 here.
19048
19049 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
19050 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
19051 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
19052 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
19053 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
19054
19055 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
19056 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019057 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019058 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
19059 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
19060
19061 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
19062 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
19063 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
19064 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
19065 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
19066 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
19067 between haproxy and the server.
19068
19069 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
19070 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
19071 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
19072 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
19073 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
19074 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
19075 solution is to fix the application.
19076
19077 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
19078 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
19079 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
19080 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
19081 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
19082 external attacks.
19083
19084 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
19085 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020019086 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019087 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
19088 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
19089
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019090 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
19091 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
19092 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019093 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020019094 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019095
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019096 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
19097 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
19098 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
19099 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019100 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
19101 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
19102 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
19103 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
19104 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019105
19106 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
19107 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
19108 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
19109 returned an HTTP 403 error.
19110
19111 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
19112 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
19113 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
19114 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
19115
19116 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
19117 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
19118 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
19119 only be solved by proper system tuning.
19120
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019121The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
19122persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
19123important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
19124re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
19125
19126 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
19127
19128 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
19129 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
19130 set on a GET request.
19131
19132 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
19133 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019134 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019135 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
19136
19137 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
19138 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
19139 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
19140
19141 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
19142 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
19143 already got a cookie.
19144
19145 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
19146 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
19147 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
19148 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
19149 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
19150
19151 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
19152 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
19153 new cookie was inserted in the response.
19154
19155 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
19156 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
19157 new cookie was inserted in the response.
19158
19159 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
19160 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
19161
19162 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
19163 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
19164 then advertised in the response.
19165
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019166
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200191678.6. Non-printable characters
19168-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019169
19170In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
19171consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
19172converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
19173prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
19174being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
19175escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
19176is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
19177'}' when logging headers.
19178
19179Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
19180issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
19181containing spaces is "User-Agent".
19182
19183Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
19184the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
19185performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
19186
19187
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200191888.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
19189---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019190
19191Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
19192achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019193section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019194cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
19195the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
19196the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019197locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019198not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
19199user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
19200a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
19201wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
19202
19203 Examples :
19204 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
19205 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
19206
19207 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
19208 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
19209
19210
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200192118.8. Capturing HTTP headers
19212---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019213
19214Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
19215proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
19216the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
19217server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
19218
19219Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
19220response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019221section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019222
19223It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019224time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
19225appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019226are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
19227and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
19228follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
19229request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
19230in the logs.
19231
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020019232As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
19233frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
19234an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
19235
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019236 Example :
19237 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
19238 listen proxy-out
19239 mode http
19240 option httplog
19241 option logasap
19242 log global
19243 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
19244
19245 # log the name of the virtual server
19246 capture request header Host len 20
19247
19248 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
19249 capture request header Content-Length len 10
19250
19251 # log the beginning of the referrer
19252 capture request header Referer len 20
19253
19254 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
19255 capture response header Server len 20
19256
19257 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
19258 capture response header Content-Length len 10
19259
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019260 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019261 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
19262
19263 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
19264 capture response header Via len 20
19265
19266 # log the URL location during a redirection
19267 capture response header Location len 20
19268
19269 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
19270 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
19271 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19272 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
19273 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
19274
19275 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
19276 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
19277 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19278 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019279 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019280
19281 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
19282 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
19283 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19284 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
19285 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019286 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019287
19288
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200192898.9. Examples of logs
19290---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019291
19292These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
19293them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
19294reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
19295
19296 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
19297 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
19298 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
19299
19300 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
19301 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
19302
19303 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
19304 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
19305 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
19306
19307 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
19308 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
19309
19310 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
19311 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
19312 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
19313
19314 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019315 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019316 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
19317 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
19318
19319 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
19320 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
19321 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
19322
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020019323 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
19324 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
19325 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
19326 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
19327 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
19328 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019329
19330 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019331 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019332
19333 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
19334 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
19335 Nothing was sent to any server.
19336
19337 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
19338 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
19339
19340 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
19341 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019342 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019343 send a 408 return code to the client.
19344
19345 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
19346 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
19347
19348 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
19349 5 seconds ("c----").
19350
19351 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
19352 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019353 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019354
19355 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019356 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019357 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
19358 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
19359 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
19360 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
19361 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010019362
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020019363
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200193649. Supported filters
19365--------------------
19366
19367Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
19368accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
19369unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
19370
19371See also : "filter"
19372
193739.1. Trace
19374----------
19375
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010019376filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019377
19378 Arguments:
19379 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
19380 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
19381
19382 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
19383 the client and the server. By default, this filter
19384 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
19385 only parses a random amount of the available data.
19386
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019387 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019388 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
19389 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
19390 amount of the parsed data.
19391
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019392 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010019393
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019394This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
19395callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
19396information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
19397filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
19398
19399Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
19400tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
19401a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
19402
19403
194049.2. HTTP compression
19405---------------------
19406
19407filter compression
19408
19409The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
19410keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019411when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
19412fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
19413done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
19414explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
19415filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
19416listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
19417order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019418
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019419See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
19420 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019421
19422
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200194239.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
19424--------------------------------------------
19425
19426filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
19427
19428 Arguments :
19429
19430 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
19431 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
19432 parsed.
19433
19434 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
19435 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
19436 part must be placed in its own scope.
19437
19438The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
19439external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019440streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020019441exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
19442also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
19443
19444SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
19445the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
19446
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010019447For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020019448"doc/SPOE.txt".
19449
19450Important note:
19451 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
19452 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
19453
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100194549.4. Cache
19455----------
19456
19457filter cache <name>
19458
19459 Arguments :
19460
19461 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
19462
19463The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
19464"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019465cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019466other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
19467case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
19468is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
19469filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010019470listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
19471order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010019472
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019473See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
19474 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
19475
19476
194779.5. Fcgi-app
19478-------------
19479
19480filter fcg-app <name>
19481
19482 Arguments :
19483
19484 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
19485
19486The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
19487request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
19488reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
19489used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
19490implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
19491used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
19492fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
19493used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
19494order.
19495
19496See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
19497 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
19498
19499
1950010. FastCGI applications
19501-------------------------
19502
19503HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
19504feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
19505the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
19506FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
19507servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
19508FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
19509backend.
19510
19511HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
19512application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
19513connection.
19514
1951510.1. Setup
19516-----------
19517
1951810.1.1. Fcgi-app section
19519--------------------------
19520
19521fcgi-app <name>
19522 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
19523 document root must be defined.
19524
19525acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
19526 Declare or complete an access list.
19527
19528 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
19529 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
19530 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
19531 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
19532 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
19533
19534docroot <path>
19535 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
19536 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
19537 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
19538
19539index <script-name>
19540 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
19541 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
19542 is an optional setting.
19543
19544 Example :
19545 index index.php
19546
19547log-stderr global
19548log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
19549 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
19550 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
19551
19552 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
19553 default STDERR messages are ignored.
19554
19555pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
19556 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
19557 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
19558 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
19559
19560 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
19561 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
19562 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
19563 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
19564
19565 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
19566 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
19567
19568path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010019569 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010019570 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
19571 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
19572 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
19573 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
19574 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
19575 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
19576 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010019577
19578 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019579 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010019580 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
19581 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
19582 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
19583 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019584
19585 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010019586 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
19587 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019588
19589option get-values
19590no option get-values
19591 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
19592
19593 HAproxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
19594 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
19595
19596 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
19597 application will accept.
19598
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020019599 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
19600 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019601
19602 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
19603 the connexion immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
19604 option is disabled.
19605
19606 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
19607 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
19608 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
19609 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
19610 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
19611 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
19612
19613option keep-conn
19614no option keep-conn
19615 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
19616 sending a response.
19617
19618 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
19619 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
19620
19621option max-reqs <reqs>
19622 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
19623 accept.
19624
19625 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
19626 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
19627 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
19628 to 1.
19629
19630option mpxs-conns
19631no option mpxs-conns
19632 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
19633
19634 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
19635 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
19636
19637set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
19638 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
19639 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
19640 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
19641 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
19642
19643 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
19644 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
19645 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
19646
19647 Example :
19648 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
19649 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
19650
19651 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
19652
19653
1965410.1.2. Proxy section
19655---------------------
19656
19657use-fcgi-app <name>
19658 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
19659
19660 Arguments :
19661 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
19662
19663 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
19664 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
19665 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
19666 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
19667 application may be defined at a time per backend.
19668
19669 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
19670 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
19671 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
19672 application are evaluated.
19673
19674
1967510.1.3. Example
19676---------------
19677
19678 frontend front-http
19679 mode http
19680 bind *:80
19681 bind *:
19682
19683 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
19684 default_backend back-static
19685
19686 backend back-static
19687 mode http
19688 server www A.B.C.D:80
19689
19690 backend back-dynamic
19691 mode http
19692 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
19693 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
19694
19695 fcgi-app php-fpm
19696 log-stderr global
19697 option keep-conn
19698
19699 docroot /var/www/my-app
19700 index index.php
19701 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
19702
19703
1970410.2. Default parameters
19705------------------------
19706
19707A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
19708the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019709script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019710applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
19711
19712 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19713 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
19714 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
19715 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
19716 | | |
19717 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19718 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
19719 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
19720 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
19721 | | application. |
19722 | | |
19723 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19724 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
19725 | | the request. It may not be set. |
19726 | | |
19727 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19728 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
19729 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
19730 | | the application's configuration. |
19731 | | |
19732 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19733 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
19734 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
19735 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
19736 | | |
19737 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19738 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
19739 | | following the part that identifies the script |
19740 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
19741 | | be defined. |
19742 | | |
19743 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19744 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
19745 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
19746 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
19747 | | is not set too. |
19748 | | |
19749 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19750 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
19751 | | set. |
19752 | | |
19753 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19754 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
19755 | | the request. |
19756 | | |
19757 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19758 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
19759 | | client as part of user authentication. |
19760 | | |
19761 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19762 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
19763 | | script to process the request. |
19764 | | |
19765 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19766 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
19767 | | |
19768 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19769 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
19770 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
19771 | | |
19772 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19773 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
19774 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
19775 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
19776 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
19777 | | |
19778 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19779 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
19780 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
19781 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
19782 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
19783 | | side. |
19784 | | |
19785 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19786 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
19787 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
19788 | | connected to. |
19789 | | |
19790 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19791 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
19792 | | |
19793 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19794 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
19795 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
19796 | | |
19797 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19798
19799
1980010.3. Limitations
19801------------------
19802
19803The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
19804way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
19805during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
19806establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
19807application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
19808or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
19809message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
19810these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
19811and HTTP servers under the same backend.
19812
19813Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
19814request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
19815requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
19816
19817About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
19818into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
19819fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
19820"http-request" ones.
19821
19822Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
19823FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
19824processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
19825must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
19826here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010019827
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019828/*
19829 * Local variables:
19830 * fill-column: 79
19831 * End:
19832 */